Peerless Industries Kx Tda100 Users Manual Feature_guide

KX-TDA30 to the manual 9cd16708-4129-47e0-9ec5-cb9a20c542a5

2015-02-06

: Peerless-Industries Peerless-Industries-Kx-Tda100-Users-Manual-517547 peerless-industries-kx-tda100-users-manual-517547 peerless-industries pdf

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 380

DownloadPeerless-Industries Peerless-Industries-Kx-Tda100-Users-Manual- Feature_guide  Peerless-industries-kx-tda100-users-manual
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
Hybrid IP-PBX

Feature Guide

Model

KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30
KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200

Thank you for purchasing the Panasonic KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200, Hybrid IP-PBX.
Please read this manual carefully before using this product and save this manual for future use.
KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200: Version 1.1

Introduction
About this Feature Guide
This Feature Guide is designed to serve as an overall feature reference for the Panasonic
Hybrid IP-PBX.
It explains what this PBX can do, and how to obtain the most out of its many features and
facilities.
This manual contains the following sections:

Section 1, Call Handling Features
Provides details about the call handling features.

Section 2, System Configuration and Administration Features
Provides details about the system configuration and administration features.

Section 3, Programming
Provides system programming instructions.

Section 4, Appendix
Provides tables listing capacity of system resources, and tones and ring tones. It also provides
the list of abbreviations.

Index
Provide feature titles, important words to help you access the required information easily.

Terms used in this Feature Guide
Installation Manual References
The required installation instruction titles described in the Installation Manual are noted for your
reference.

Feature Guide References
The related feature titles described in this Feature Guide are noted for your reference.

User Manual References
The operation required to implement the feature described in the User Manual is noted for your
reference.

Abbreviations
There are many abbreviations used in this manual (e.g., "PT" which stands for proprietary
telephone). Please refer to the list in this manual ( 4.3 List of Abbreviations) for the meaning
of each abbreviation.

About the other manuals
Along with this Feature Guide, the following manuals are available to help you install, and use
this PBX:

2

Feature Guide

Installation Manual
Provides instructions for installing the hardware and maintenance of the PBX.

User Manual
Provides operating instructions for end users using PTs, SLTs, PSs, or DSS Consoles.

Changed from:
The KX-TDA30E, the KX-TDA30NE, the KX-TDA30GR, and the
KX-TDA30CE are designed to interwork with the:
The KX-TDA15E/KX-TDA30E, the KX-TDA15NE/KX-TDA30NE, the KX-TDA15GR/KXTDA30GR, and the KX-TDA30CE are designed to interwork with the:
Analogue Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) of a European country
Pan-European Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) using ISDN basic rate access
The KX-TDA100E/KX-TDA200E, the KX-TDA100NE/KX-TDA200NE, the KX-TDA100GR/
KX-TDA200GR, and the KX-TDA100CE/KX-TDA200CE are designed to interwork with the:
Analogue Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) of a European country
Pan-European Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) using ISDN basic rate access
Pan-European Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) using ISDN primary rate access
ONP 2048 kbit/s digital structured leased lines (D2048S)

We, Panasonic Communications Co., Ltd./Panasonic Communications Company (U.K.) Ltd.,
declare that this equipment is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant
provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
If you would like to receive a copy of the original Declaration of Conformity of our products which
relates to the R&TTE, please visit our web address:

http://doc.panasonic.de

Trademarks
•
Microsoft and Windows are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft
Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
•
Intel and Pentium are trademarks or registered trademarks of Intel Corporation or its
subsidiaries in the United States and other countries.
•
All other trademarks identified herein are the property of their respective owners.
•
Screen shots reprinted with permission from Microsoft Corporation.

Notes
•

•
•

There are some optional service cards, PTs, and features which are not available in
some areas. Additionally, there are some optional service cards and features for the
KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 which are not available for the KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30, or
vice versa. Please consult your certified Panasonic dealer for more information.
Displays are described in English as samples.
While all system programming can be performed through PC programming ( 2.3.1
PC Programming), PT programming can only cover a subset ( 2.3.2 PT
Programming). In Section 1 Call Handling Features and Section 2 System
Configuration and Administration Features, programming references such as "
Date & Time [000]" indicate that system programming can be done by PT
programming.

Feature Guide

3

For further details, please refer to the on-line help of the Maintenance Console (
3.2.1 Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console).

Feature Highlights
Networking Features
This PBX supports the following networking features:
TIE Line Service
A TIE line is a privately leased communication line between two or more PBXs, which
provides cost effective communications between company members at different locations.
( 1.28.1 TIE Line Service)
Virtual Private Network (VPN)
VPN is a service provided by the telephone company. It uses an existing line as if it were
a private line. ( 1.28.2 Virtual Private Network (VPN))
QSIG Network
QSIG is a protocol which is based on ISDN (Q.931) and offers enhanced PBX features in
a private network. ( 1.28.3 QSIG Network)
Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network
The PBX can connect to another PBX via a private IP network. In this case, voice signals
are converted into IP packets and sent through this network. ( 1.28.4 Voice over Internet
Protocol (VoIP) Network)

Built-in Small Call Centre Features
An incoming call distribution group ( 1.2.2 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features) can
be used as a small call centre with the following features:
Queuing Feature
When a preprogrammed number of extensions in an incoming call distribution group are
busy, additional incoming calls can wait in a queue. While calls are waiting in the queue,
the calls are handled by the Queuing Time Table, which can be assigned for each time
mode (day/lunch/break/night). ( 1.2.2.3 Queuing Feature)
Log-in/Log-out
Incoming call distribution group members can join (Log-in) or leave (Log-out) the groups
manually. While logged-in, a member extension can have a preprogrammed time period
automatically for refusing calls after completing the last call (Wrap-up). ( 1.2.2.6 Login/Log-out)
VIP Call
It is possible to assign a priority to incoming call distribution groups. If an extension
belongs to multiple groups and the extension becomes idle, queuing calls in the groups
will be distributed to the extension in priority order. ( 1.2.2.4 VIP Call)

Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Features
Connecting a personal computer (PC) to this PBX (via a DPT, or via a Server PC on a LAN)
enables extension users to make use of advanced features by using the stored data in the PC
or in the Server PC. ( 1.29.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI))

Voice Mail Features
This PBX supports Voice Processing Systems (VPS) with DTMF Integration as well as DPT
(Digital) Integration. ( 1.23 Voice Mail Features)

4

Feature Guide

Parallelled Telephone Features
By connecting telephones in parallel, you can increase the number of telephones connected
to the PBX without adding additional extension cards. ( 1.10.9 Parallelled Telephone)
Parallel Mode
An SLT can be connected to an APT or DPT which is connected to a Super Hybrid port of
the PBX. The SLT shares the same extension number with the APT or DPT.
EXtra Device Port (XDP) Mode
An SLT can be connected to a DPT which is connected to a Super Hybrid port of the PBX.
Unlike parallel mode, XDP mode allows each telephone to act as an independent
extension with its own extension number.
Digital XDP
A DPT can be connected to another DPT which is connected to a DPT port or a Super
Hybrid port of the PBX. Similar to XDP mode, each DPT acts as an independent extension
with its own extension number.

Portable Station (PS) Features
PSs (e.g., KX-TD7590, KX-TD7690) can be connected to this PBX. It is possible to use the
PBX features using the PS like a PT. A PS can also be used in parallel with a wired telephone
(Wireless XDP Parallel Mode). In this case, the wired telephone is the main telephone and
the PS is the sub telephone. ( 1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features)

PC Phone/PC Console Features
This PBX supports PC Phone and PC Console. These Panasonic CTI applications provide
advanced features.

Feature Guide

5

Table of Contents
1

6

Call Handling Features ................................................................. 15

1.1
1.1.1

Incoming Call Features........................................................................................ 16
Incoming Trunk Call Features................................................................................. 16

1.1.1.1
1.1.1.2
1.1.1.3
1.1.1.4
1.1.1.5
1.1.1.6
1.1.1.7

Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY......................................................................................... 16
Direct In Line (DIL) ............................................................................................................................... 19
Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI)............................................................................. 21
Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service ........................................................................... 24
Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution ......................................................................................... 27
Intercept Routing.................................................................................................................................. 29
Intercept Routing—No Destination....................................................................................................... 32

1.1.2

Internal Call Features ............................................................................................. 33

1.1.2.1
1.1.2.2

Internal Call Features—SUMMARY ..................................................................................................... 33
Internal Call Block ................................................................................................................................ 34

1.1.3

Incoming Call Indication Features .......................................................................... 36

1.1.3.1
1.1.3.2
1.1.3.3

Incoming Call Indication Features—SUMMARY .................................................................................. 36
Ring Tone Pattern Selection................................................................................................................. 37
Call Waiting .......................................................................................................................................... 38

1.2
1.2.1
1.2.2

Receiving Group Features................................................................................... 40
Idle Extension Hunting ........................................................................................... 40
Incoming Call Distribution Group Features............................................................. 42

1.2.2.1
1.2.2.2
1.2.2.3
1.2.2.4
1.2.2.5
1.2.2.6
1.2.2.7

Incoming Call Distribution Group Features—SUMMARY .................................................................... 42
Group Call Distribution ......................................................................................................................... 46
Queuing Feature .................................................................................................................................. 49
VIP Call ................................................................................................................................................ 51
Overflow Feature.................................................................................................................................. 52
Log-in/Log-out ...................................................................................................................................... 54
Supervisory Feature............................................................................................................................. 56

1.3
1.3.1

Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features ................................... 58
Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) ....................................................... 58

1.3.1.1
1.3.1.2
1.3.1.3

Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—SUMMARY ............................................................... 58
Call Forwarding (FWD)......................................................................................................................... 61
Do Not Disturb (DND) .......................................................................................................................... 65

1.4
1.4.1

Answering Features ............................................................................................. 66
Answering Features................................................................................................ 66

1.4.1.1
1.4.1.2
1.4.1.3
1.4.1.4

Answering Features—SUMMARY........................................................................................................ 66
Line Preference—Incoming.................................................................................................................. 67
Call Pickup ........................................................................................................................................... 68
Hands-free Answerback ....................................................................................................................... 69

1.5
1.5.1
1.5.2
1.5.3
1.5.4

Making Call Features ........................................................................................... 70
Predialling............................................................................................................... 70
Automatic Extension Release................................................................................. 71
Intercom Call .......................................................................................................... 72
Trunk Call Features ................................................................................................ 73

1.5.4.1
1.5.4.2
1.5.4.3
1.5.4.4
1.5.4.5
1.5.4.6
1.5.4.7
1.5.4.8

Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY ........................................................................................................ 73
Emergency Call.................................................................................................................................... 74
Account Code Entry ............................................................................................................................. 75
Dial Type Selection............................................................................................................................... 76
Reverse Circuit..................................................................................................................................... 77
Pause Insertion .................................................................................................................................... 78
Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX) ....................... 79
Special Carrier Access Code ............................................................................................................... 81

1.5.5

Seizing a Line Features.......................................................................................... 82

1.5.5.1

Seizing a Line Features—SUMMARY.................................................................................................. 82

Feature Guide

1.5.5.2
1.5.5.3

Line Preference—Outgoing ................................................................................................................. 83
Trunk Access ....................................................................................................................................... 84

1.6
1.6.1

Memory Dialling Features ....................................................................................86
Memory Dialling Features .......................................................................................86

1.6.1.1
1.6.1.2
1.6.1.3
1.6.1.4
1.6.1.5
1.6.1.6
1.6.1.7

Memory Dialling Features—SUMMARY .............................................................................................. 86
One-touch Dialling ............................................................................................................................... 88
KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) ............................................................ 89
Last Number Redial ............................................................................................................................. 90
Speed Dialling—Personal/System ....................................................................................................... 91
Quick Dialling ....................................................................................................................................... 92
Hot Line................................................................................................................................................ 93

1.7
1.7.1
1.7.2
1.7.3
1.7.4

Busy Line/Busy Party Features ...........................................................................94
Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-on) ......................................................................94
Executive Busy Override .........................................................................................95
Call Monitor.............................................................................................................96
Second Call Notification to Busy Extension ............................................................97

1.7.4.1
1.7.4.2
1.7.4.3
1.7.4.4

Second Call Notification to Busy Extension—SUMMARY ................................................................... 97
Call Waiting Tone ................................................................................................................................. 99
Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA) ............................................................................................... 100
Whisper OHCA .................................................................................................................................. 101

1.8
1.8.1
1.8.2
1.8.3
1.8.4
1.8.5
1.8.6
1.9
1.9.1
1.10
1.10.1
1.10.2
1.10.3
1.10.4
1.10.5
1.10.6
1.10.7
1.10.8
1.10.9
1.10.10
1.11
1.11.1
1.12
1.12.1
1.12.2
1.12.3
1.12.4
1.13
1.13.1

Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features ....................................102
Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) .........................................................102
Budget Management.............................................................................................107
Extension Lock......................................................................................................108
Dial Tone Transfer .................................................................................................109
Walking COS.........................................................................................................110
Verified Code Entry ...............................................................................................111
Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features .....................................................113
Automatic Route Selection (ARS) .........................................................................113
Conversation Features .......................................................................................118
Hands-free Operation ...........................................................................................118
Off-hook Monitor ...................................................................................................119
Mute ......................................................................................................................120
Headset Operation ................................................................................................121
Data Line Security.................................................................................................122
Flash/Recall/Terminate .........................................................................................123
External Feature Access (EFA).............................................................................124
Trunk Call Limitation..............................................................................................125
Parallelled Telephone ............................................................................................126
Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection .......................................................129
Transferring Features .........................................................................................130
Call Transfer ..........................................................................................................130
Holding Features.................................................................................................132
Call Hold ...............................................................................................................132
Call Park................................................................................................................134
Call Splitting ..........................................................................................................135
Music on Hold .......................................................................................................136
Conference Features ..........................................................................................137
Conference Features ............................................................................................137

1.13.1.1
1.13.1.2
1.13.1.3

Conference Features—SUMMARY.................................................................................................... 137
Conference ........................................................................................................................................ 138
Privacy Release ................................................................................................................................. 140

1.14

Paging Features ..................................................................................................141

Feature Guide

7

8

1.14.1
1.15
1.15.1
1.16
1.16.1
1.16.2
1.16.3
1.16.4
1.16.5
1.16.6
1.17
1.17.1
1.17.2
1.18
1.18.1
1.18.2
1.19
1.19.1
1.19.2
1.19.3
1.19.4
1.20
1.20.1

Paging .................................................................................................................. 141
Broadcasting Features (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) ................ 143
Broadcasting (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) .................................... 143
Optional Device Features .................................................................................. 146
Doorphone Call .................................................................................................... 146
Door Open............................................................................................................ 148
Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS) ............................................................. 149
Background Music (BGM) .................................................................................... 150
Outgoing Message (OGM) ................................................................................... 151
Direct Inward System Access (DISA) ................................................................... 153
Caller ID Features............................................................................................... 160
Caller ID ............................................................................................................... 160
Incoming Call Log................................................................................................. 165
Message Features .............................................................................................. 167
Message Waiting .................................................................................................. 167
Absent Message................................................................................................... 170
Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features ............................................................... 171
Fixed Buttons ....................................................................................................... 171
Flexible Buttons .................................................................................................... 174
LED Indication ...................................................................................................... 177
Display Information............................................................................................... 180
Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features ....................... 182
Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) ......................................................... 182

1.20.1.1
1.20.1.2
1.20.1.3
1.20.1.4
1.20.1.5
1.20.1.6
1.20.1.7
1.20.1.8
1.20.1.9
1.20.1.10
1.20.1.11
1.20.1.12

Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY ................................................................. 182
Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) ..................................................... 186
Advice of Charge (AOC) .................................................................................................................... 188
Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-MP)............................................................................................. 189
Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P)................................................................................................ 191
Call Hold (HOLD)—by ISDN .............................................................................................................. 193
Call Transfer (CT)—by ISDN .............................................................................................................. 194
Three-party Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN........................................................................................ 195
Malicious Call Identification (MCID) ................................................................................................... 196
Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) ............................................................................... 197
ISDN Extension.................................................................................................................................. 198
ISDN Service Access by Keypad Protocol ......................................................................................... 200

1.21
1.21.1
1.22
1.22.1
1.23
1.23.1
1.23.2
1.23.3
1.24
1.24.1
1.24.2
1.24.3
1.24.4
1.24.5
1.25
1.25.1
1.25.2

E1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) ............................... 201
E1 Line Service (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) .................................................. 201
T1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) ............................... 203
T1 Line Service (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) .................................................. 203
Voice Mail Features ............................................................................................ 205
Voice Mail (VM) Group ......................................................................................... 205
Voice Mail DTMF Integration ................................................................................ 208
Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration...................................................................... 215
Portable Station (PS) Features.......................................................................... 220
Portable Station (PS) Connection......................................................................... 220
PS Ring Group ..................................................................................................... 222
PS Directory ......................................................................................................... 225
PS Feature Buttons .............................................................................................. 226
Wireless XDP Parallel Mode ................................................................................ 227
Administrative Information Output Features ................................................... 230
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) ......................................................... 230
Charge Meter ....................................................................................................... 236

Feature Guide

1.26
1.26.1
1.26.2
1.26.3
1.26.4
1.26.5
1.27
1.27.1
1.27.2
1.28
1.28.1
1.28.2
1.28.3

Extension Controlling Features.........................................................................239
Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN)...................................................239
Extension Feature Clear .......................................................................................241
Walking Extension.................................................................................................242
Timed Reminder ...................................................................................................243
Remote Extension Control by User.......................................................................244
Audible Tone Features........................................................................................245
Dial Tone ...............................................................................................................245
Confirmation Tone.................................................................................................246
Networking Features...........................................................................................247
TIE Line Service....................................................................................................247
Virtual Private Network (VPN)...............................................................................266
QSIG Network.......................................................................................................268

1.28.3.1
1.28.3.2
1.28.3.3
1.28.3.4
1.28.3.5

QSIG Network—SUMMARY .............................................................................................................. 268
Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name
Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG......................................................................... 270
Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG ........................................................................................................ 272
Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG ............................................................................................................. 274
Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)—by QSIG.............................................................. 276

1.28.4
1.29
1.29.1

Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network .........................................................277
Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Features..............................................278
Computer Telephony Integration (CTI)..................................................................278

2

System Configuration and Administration Features............... 281

2.1
2.1.1
2.2
2.2.1
2.2.2
2.2.3
2.2.4
2.2.5
2.2.6
2.3
2.3.1
2.3.2
2.3.3
2.3.4
2.3.5
2.3.6
2.3.7
2.4
2.4.1
2.4.2
2.4.3

3

System Configuration—Hardware.....................................................................282
Extension Port Configuration ................................................................................282
System Configuration—Software ......................................................................283
Class of Service (COS).........................................................................................283
Group ....................................................................................................................284
Tenant Service ......................................................................................................287
Time Service .........................................................................................................290
Operator Features.................................................................................................294
Manager Features.................................................................................................295
System Data Control...........................................................................................297
PC Programming...................................................................................................297
PT Programming ...................................................................................................300
Quick Setup...........................................................................................................302
Automatic Setup....................................................................................................303
Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering...................................................................305
Floating Extension ................................................................................................310
Software Upgrading ..............................................................................................311
Fault Recovery/Diagnostics ...............................................................................312
Power Failure Transfer (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) ......................312
Power Failure Restart............................................................................................314
Local Alarm Information ........................................................................................315

Programming Instructions ......................................................... 317

3.1
3.1.1
3.2
3.2.1
3.3

Introduction .........................................................................................................318
Introduction ...........................................................................................................318
PC Programming.................................................................................................319
Installing and Starting the Maintenance Console..................................................319
PT Programming .................................................................................................324
Feature Guide

9

3.3.1
3.3.2

Programming Instructions .................................................................................... 324
Basic Programming .............................................................................................. 329
Date & Time [000] .............................................................................................................................. 329
System Speed Dialling Number [001] ................................................................................................ 329
System Speed Dialling Name [002] ................................................................................................... 329
Extension Number [003]..................................................................................................................... 329
Extension Name [004]........................................................................................................................ 330
Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) [005] ....................................................................... 330
Operator Assignment [006] ................................................................................................................ 330
Console Paired Telephone [007] ........................................................................................................ 330
Absent Message [008] ....................................................................................................................... 330
Charge Margin [010] .......................................................................................................................... 331
Charge Tax [011]................................................................................................................................ 331
Charge Rate per Unit [012] ................................................................................................................ 331

3.3.3

System Programming ........................................................................................... 332
Flexible Numbering [100] ................................................................................................................... 332
Time Service Switching Mode [101]................................................................................................... 332
Time Service Starting Time [102] ...................................................................................................... 332
Idle Line Access (Local Access) [103] ............................................................................................... 333
System Password for Administrator—for PT Programming [110]....................................................... 333
System Password for User—for PT Programming [111] .................................................................... 333
Manager Password [112] ................................................................................................................... 333
Verified Code [120]............................................................................................................................. 333
Verified Code Name [121] .................................................................................................................. 333
Verified Code Personal Identification Number (PIN) [122] ................................................................. 333
Verified Code COS Number [123] ...................................................................................................... 334
Decimal Point Position for Currency [130].......................................................................................... 334
Currency [131].................................................................................................................................... 334
Main Processing (MPR) Software Version Reference [190]............................................................... 334

3.3.4

Time Programming ............................................................................................... 335
Hold Recall Time [200]....................................................................................................................... 335
Transfer Recall Time [201] ................................................................................................................. 335
Intercept Time [203] ........................................................................................................................... 335
Hot Line Waiting Time [204] ............................................................................................................... 335
Automatic Redial Repeat Times [205]................................................................................................ 335
Automatic Redial Interval [206] .......................................................................................................... 335
Door Open Duration Time [207] ......................................................................................................... 335
Call Duration Count Starting Time for LCOT [208]............................................................................. 336
DISA Delayed Answer Time [209]...................................................................................................... 336
DISA Trunk-to-Trunk Call Prolong Time [210] .................................................................................... 336
DISA Intercept Time [211].................................................................................................................. 336

3.3.5

TRS/Barring/ARS Programming........................................................................... 337
TRS/Barring Override by System Speed Dialling [300]...................................................................... 337
TRS/Barring Denied Code [301] ........................................................................................................ 337
TRS/Barring Exception Code [302] .................................................................................................... 337
Special Carrier Access Code [303] .................................................................................................... 337
Emergency Number [304] .................................................................................................................. 337
ARS Mode [320]................................................................................................................................. 337
ARS Leading Number [321] ............................................................................................................... 338
ARS Routing Plan Table Number [322].............................................................................................. 338
ARS Exception Number [325] ............................................................................................................ 338
ARS Routing Plan Time Table [330]................................................................................................... 338
ARS Routing Plan Table (1–16) [331–346] ........................................................................................ 339
ARS Carrier Name [350] .................................................................................................................... 339
ARS Trunk Group for Carrier Access [351] ........................................................................................ 339
ARS Removed Number of Digits for Carrier Access [352] ................................................................. 339
ARS Carrier Access Code [353] ........................................................................................................ 339

3.3.6

Trunk Programming .............................................................................................. 340
LCOT/BRI Trunk Connection [400]..................................................................................................... 340

10

Feature Guide

LCOT/BRI Trunk Name [401] ............................................................................................................. 340
LCOT/BRI Trunk Group Number [402]............................................................................................... 340
LCOT/BRI Trunk Number Reference [409] ........................................................................................ 341
LCOT Dialling Mode [410].................................................................................................................. 341
LCOT Pulse Rate [411]...................................................................................................................... 341
LCOT DTMF Minimum Duration [412] ............................................................................................... 341
LCOT CPC Signal Detection Time—Outgoing [413] ......................................................................... 341
LCOT CPC Signal Detection Time—Incoming [414] ......................................................................... 341
LCOT Reverse Circuit [415] ............................................................................................................... 341
LCOT Pause Time [416] .................................................................................................................... 342
LCOT Flash/Recall Time [417]........................................................................................................... 342
LCOT Disconnect Time [418]............................................................................................................. 342
BRI Network Type [420] ..................................................................................................................... 342
BRI DIL/DDI/MSN Selection [421] ..................................................................................................... 342
BRI Subscriber Number [422]............................................................................................................ 342
BRI Layer 1 Active Mode [424] .......................................................................................................... 342
BRI Layer 2 Active Mode [425] .......................................................................................................... 343
BRI Configuration [426]...................................................................................................................... 343
BRI TEI Mode [427] ........................................................................................................................... 343
DIL 1:1 Destination [450] ................................................................................................................... 343
DID Number [451] .............................................................................................................................. 343
DID Name [452] ................................................................................................................................. 344
DID Destination [453]......................................................................................................................... 344
Trunk Group Intercept Destination [470] ............................................................................................ 344
Host PBX Access Code [471] ............................................................................................................ 344
Extension-to-Trunk Call Duration [472] .............................................................................................. 344
Trunk-to-Trunk Call Duration [473] ..................................................................................................... 344
DISA Silence Detection [475]............................................................................................................. 345
DISA Continuous Signal Detection [476] ........................................................................................... 345
DISA Cyclic Signal Detection [477].................................................................................................... 345
Caller ID Signal Type [490] (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) ............................................ 345
Pay Tone Signal Type [491] (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only).............................................................. 345

3.3.7

COS Programming................................................................................................346
Trunk Group Number [500] ................................................................................................................ 346
TRS/Barring Level [501]..................................................................................................................... 346
Trunk Call Duration Limitation [502] ................................................................................................... 346
Call Transfer to Trunk [503] ................................................................................................................ 346
Call Forwarding to Trunk [504] ........................................................................................................... 346
Executive Busy Override [505]........................................................................................................... 347
Executive Busy Override Deny [506] ................................................................................................. 347
DND Override [507] ........................................................................................................................... 347
Account Code Mode [508] ................................................................................................................. 347
TRS/Barring Level for System Speed Dialling [509] .......................................................................... 347
TRS/Barring Level for Extension Lock [510] ...................................................................................... 347
Manager Assignment [511] ................................................................................................................ 347
Permission for Door Open Access [512] ............................................................................................ 348
Time Service Manual Switching [514]................................................................................................ 348
Wireless XDP Parallel Mode for Paired Telephone [515] ................................................................... 348
Programming Mode Limitation [516] .................................................................................................. 348

3.3.8

Extension Programming........................................................................................349
EXtra Device Port (XDP) Mode [600]................................................................................................. 349
Terminal Device Assignment [601]..................................................................................................... 349
Class of Service [602]........................................................................................................................ 349
User Group [603] ............................................................................................................................... 349
Extension Intercept Destination [604] ................................................................................................ 349
Call Forwarding—No Answer Time [605]........................................................................................... 349
CLIP/COLP Number [606] ................................................................................................................. 350
Incoming Call Distribution Group Member [620] ................................................................................ 350
Incoming Call Distribution Group Delayed Ringing [621] ................................................................... 350

Feature Guide

11

Incoming Call Distribution Group Floating Extension Number [622] .................................................. 350
Incoming Call Distribution Group Name [623].................................................................................... 350
Incoming Call Distribution Group Distribution Method [624] .............................................................. 350
Destination for Overflow Time Expiration [625] .................................................................................. 351
Overflow Time [626] ........................................................................................................................... 351
Destination When All Busy [627]........................................................................................................ 351
Queuing Call Capacity [628] .............................................................................................................. 351
Queuing Hurry-up Level [629] ............................................................................................................ 351
Queuing Time Table [630] .................................................................................................................. 352
Sequences in Queuing Time Table [631] ........................................................................................... 352
Maximum Number of Agents [632]..................................................................................................... 352
User Groups of a Paging Group [640]................................................................................................ 352
External Pagers of a Paging Group [641]........................................................................................... 352
User Groups of a Pickup Group [650] ................................................................................................ 353
VM Group Floating Extension Number [660] ..................................................................................... 353
Idle Extension Hunting Type [680]...................................................................................................... 353
Idle Extension Hunting Group Member [681] ..................................................................................... 353
PS Registration [690] ......................................................................................................................... 354
PS Termination [691].......................................................................................................................... 354
Personal Identification Number (PIN) for PS Registration [692]......................................................... 354
CS Status Reference [699] ................................................................................................................ 354

3.3.9

Resource/Interface Programming......................................................................... 355
External Pager Floating Extension Number [700] .............................................................................. 355
Music Source Selection for BGM (with the KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30)/BGM2 (with the KX-TDA100/KXTDA200) [710].................................................................................................................................... 355
Music on Hold [711] ........................................................................................................................... 355
Music for Transfer [712]...................................................................................................................... 355
Doorphone Call Destination [720] ...................................................................................................... 356
Doorphone Number Reference [729] ................................................................................................. 356
Outgoing Message (OGM) Floating Extension Number [730]............................................................ 356
Outgoing Message (OGM) Name [731] ............................................................................................. 357
DISA Security Mode [732].................................................................................................................. 357

3.3.10

SMDR & Maintenance Programming ................................................................... 358
RS-232C Parameter—New Line Code [800]...................................................................................... 358
RS-232C Parameter—Baud Rate [800] ............................................................................................. 358
RS-232C Parameter—Word Length [800].......................................................................................... 358
RS-232C Parameter—Parity Bit [800]................................................................................................ 358
RS-232C Parameter—Stop Bit Length [800]...................................................................................... 358
External Modem Control [801] ........................................................................................................... 358
SMDR Page Length [802] .................................................................................................................. 358
SMDR Skip Perforation [803] ............................................................................................................. 359
SMDR Outgoing Call Printing [804] ................................................................................................... 359
SMDR Incoming Call Printing [805] ................................................................................................... 359
Remote Programming [810] ............................................................................................................... 359
Modem Floating Extension Number [811].......................................................................................... 359
ISDN Remote Floating Extension Number [812]................................................................................ 359

3.3.11

Card Programming ............................................................................................... 360
Slot Card Type Reference [900] ......................................................................................................... 360
Slot Card Deletion [901] ..................................................................................................................... 360
Slot Card Reset [902]......................................................................................................................... 360
OPB3 Option Card Type Reference [910] (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only) ........................................ 360
OPB3 Option Card Deletion [911] (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only).................................................... 360

4

Appendix ...................................................................................... 361

4.1
4.1.1
4.2
4.2.1

12

Capacity of System Resources ......................................................................... 362
Capacity of System Resources ............................................................................ 362
Tones/Ring Tones............................................................................................... 365
Tones/Ring Tones................................................................................................. 365

Feature Guide

4.3
4.3.1
4.4
4.4.1
4.4.2

List of Abbreviations ..........................................................................................367
List of Abbreviations..............................................................................................367
Revision History..................................................................................................369
KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 Version 1.1 ....................................................................369
KX-TDA30 Version 1.1 ..........................................................................................371

Index .................................................................................................. 373

Feature Guide

13

14

Feature Guide

Section

1

Call Handling Features

Feature Guide

15

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1

Incoming Call Features

1.1.1

Incoming Trunk Call Features

1.1.1.1

Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY

Description
Incoming calls via a trunk (public line) are distributed to their destination using a suitable
distribution feature.

1. Available Networking Type for Each Optional Trunk Card Type
Each trunk port of an optional trunk card can be assigned its networking type: Public,
Private, or VPN (Virtual Private Network).

Networking
Type

Trunk
Card
Type

Channel Type

Public
(DIL/DID/
DDI/MSN)

LCOT

*

DID

*
*

LCOT
GCOT
DID
TIE (E & M)
OPX (EXTN.)
DR2
E & M-C
E & M-P

T1

E1

*
*
*

*
*
*
*

E&M

BRI/PRI

CO
Extension
QSIG-Master
QSIG-Slave

*

*
*
*

IP-GW
Note:
*1 :
*2 :

16

Feature Guide

Private
(TIE)*1

*:

Enable (default),

: Enable

1.28.1 TIE Line Service
1.28.2 Virtual Private Network (VPN)

Virtual Private
Network
(VPN)*2

1.1 Incoming Call Features

2. Distribution Feature
One of the following features can be assigned to each trunk port:
Feature

Description

Details in

Direct In Line
(DIL)

Directs a call to a preprogrammed single
destination (e.g., Operator).

• 1.1.1.2 Direct In
Line (DIL)

Direct Inward
Dialling (DID)

Directs a call with a DID number from a DID
line to a preprogrammed destination.
DID is also known as Direct Dialling In (DDI).

• 1.1.1.3 Direct
Inward Dialling
(DID)/Direct
Dialling In (DDI)

Multiple
Subscriber
Number (MSN)
Ringing Service

Directs a call with an MSN from an ISDN line to • 1.1.1.4 Multiple
a preprogrammed destination.
Subscriber
Number (MSN)
Ringing Service

3. Destination Change with the Caller’s Identification Number
The Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution feature works in conjunction with the DIL/
DID/DDI/MSN features.
Feature

Description

Details in

Calling Line
Directs a call to a CLI destination if the caller’s • 1.1.1.5 Calling
Identification
identification number has been assigned to the Line Identification
(CLI) Distribution Caller ID Table.
(CLI) Distribution

4. Available Distribution Feature for Each Optional Trunk Card Type
Trunk
Card
Type
LCOT
DID

Feature

DID/DDI

MSN

Channel Type
*
*

LCOT
GCOT
DID
TIE (E & M)
DR2
E & M-C
E & M-P

T1

E1
E&M
BRI
PRI
Note:

DIL

*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*

CO
CO
*:

Enable (default),

*
*

: Enable

Feature Guide

17

1.1 Incoming Call Features

5. Available Destination
Destination

Availability

Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX)
PS
Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
VM Group (DTMF/DPT)
External Pager (TAFAS)
DISA
Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance
Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.
Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.
Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)
Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)

6. Intercept Routing
After distribution, the following features may be required.
Feature
Intercept No Answer
Routing (IRNA)

Busy/DND

Description

If a called party does not answer a call within • 1.1.1.6
Intercept
a preprogrammed time period (Intercept
time), it is redirected to the preprogrammed Routing
destination.
If a called party is busy or in DND mode, the
call is redirected to the preprogrammed
destination.

No
If a destination is not assigned, the call is
Destination redirected to the operator.

18

Feature Guide

Details in

• 1.1.1.7
Intercept
Routing—No
Destination

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.1.2

Direct In Line (DIL)

Description
Provides automatic direction of an incoming trunk call to a preprogrammed destination. Each
trunk has a destination for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night).
[Method Flowchart]
A trunk call is received.

Does the call have its CLI*
information and is CLI mode enabled
for the trunk and the time mode?

No

Yes
CLI works.

Yes

Is the CLI destination
assigned?
No
Is the DIL destination of
the time mode assigned?

No

Yes
The call is routed to the
CLI destination.

The call is routed to the
DIL destination.

The call is routed to the
operator (Intercept Routing
—No Destination).

*: Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution:
If the CLI routing is enabled and the caller's identification number is assigned in the Caller ID
Table, the call will not be routed to the DIL destination, but routed to the CLI destination.

Feature Guide

19

1.1 Incoming Call Features

[Programming Example of DIL Table]
The table can be programmed for each trunk.
Destination*

CLI
Trunk No.

*:

Day

Lunch

Break

Night

Day

Lunch

Break

Night

01

Enable

Disable

Enable

Disable

101

100

101

100

02

Enable

Disable Disable Disable

102

100

102

100

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

DIL 1:1 Destination [450]

Note
Tenant number and VPS trunk group number can also be assigned in the DIL table. Tenant
number is used to determine the time mode (day/lunch/break/night) for the corresponding
trunk. VPS trunk group number is used in Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration ( 1.23.3
Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration).
Explanation:
If a trunk call is received from trunk 01;
In Day mode: CLI is enabled. Route to CLI destination.
In Lunch mode: CLI is disabled. Route to DIL destination, extension 100.

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution
2.2.4 Time Service

20

Feature Guide

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.1.3

Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI)

Description
Provides automatic direction of an incoming call with a DID/DDI number to a preprogrammed
destination. Each DID/DDI number has a destination for each time mode (day/lunch/break/
night).
[Method Flowchart]

A trunk call is received.

Is the DID/DDI number found in
the DID/DDI table?

No

The call is routed to the
operator (Intercept
Routing—No Destination).

Yes

Does the call have its CLI*
information and is CLI mode
enabled for the time mode?

No

Yes
CLI works.

Yes

Is the CLI destination assigned?
No
Is the DID/DDI destination
for the time mode assigned?

No

Yes
The call is routed to the
CLI destination.

The call is routed to the
DID/DDI destination.

The call is routed to the
operator (Intercept
Routing—No Destination).

*: Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution:
If the CLI routing is enabled and the caller's identification number is assigned in the Caller ID
Table, the call will not be routed to the DID/DDI destination, but routed to the CLI destination.

Feature Guide

21

1.1 Incoming Call Features

[Programming Example of DID/DDI Table]
DDI can be programmed as DID.
DID/DDI Destination*3

CLI

Locat
ion

DID/DDI
No.*1

0001

123-4567 John White

Enabl Disabl Enabl Disabl
105
e
e
e
e

100

105

100

0002

123-2468 Tom Smith

Enabl Disabl Disabl Disabl
102
e
e
e
e

100

102

100

0003

123-456

A company

Enabl Disabl Disabl Disabl
101
e
e
e
e

101

101

100

:

:

:

:

:

:

DID/DDI
Name*2

Day Lunch Break Night Day Lunch Break Night

:

:

:

:

:

DID Number [451]
DID Name [452]
DID Destination [453]

*1:
*2:
*3:

Note
Tenant number and VPS trunk group number can also be assigned in the DID/DDI table.
Tenant number is used to determine the time mode (day/lunch/break/night) for the
corresponding DID/DDI number. VPS trunk group number is used in Voice Mail DPT
(Digital) Integration ( 1.23.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration).
Explanation:
If the DID/DDI number is "123-4567":
1. Checks the number in the table.
Matches the number in location 0001.
2. Checks the time mode.
In Day mode: CLI is enabled. Route to CLI destination.
In Lunch mode: CLI is disabled. Route to DID/DDI destination, extension 100.

Conditions
•
•

To use this feature, the DID/DDI service must be assigned for a trunk port as the
distribution method ( BRI DIL/DDI/MSN Selection [421] *For BRI only).
DID/DDI Number Modification
It is possible to modify a received DID/DDI number, which may be convenient when
programming the DID/DDI table. Modification method (removed number of digits/added
number) can be programmed on a trunk port basis.
[Modification Example]

Removed number of digits: 6
Modified DID/DDI number: 876543 21 = 1021
Added number: 10
Received DID/DDI number: 87654321
1) Remove the
first 6 digits.

22

Feature Guide

2) Add "10".

1.1 Incoming Call Features

•

The Inter-digit Time
When the Inter-digit time expires, the PBX stops receiving DID/DDI number and starts to
check the DID/DDI table. (Refer to the [Programming Example of DID/DDI Table] above).
Even if the Inter-digit time does not expire, the PBX stops receiving the DID/DDI number
when the received number is found in the DID/DDI table. The PBX then routes the call to
the corresponding destination. If the received number matches several DID/DDI numbers
in the table, the DID/DDI number of the lowest numbered location has priority.
[Example] If a call is received in Lunch mode;
Received
Number

Destination

Explanation

123-4567

Extn. 100

The PBX finds the match in location 0001
in the table after receiving "7". So the call
is routed to extension 100.

123-456

Extn. 101

The Inter-digit time expired after
receiving "6". The PBX finds the match in
location 0003 in the table. So the call is
routed to extension 101.

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution
2.2.4 Time Service

Feature Guide

23

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.1.4

Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service

Description
Provides automatic direction of an incoming ISDN-BRI (Basic Rate Interface) line call with an
MSN to a preprogrammed destination. One ISDN-BRI port can support a maximum of 10
MSNs. Each MSN has a destination for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night).
Point-to-multipoint must be selected for the ISDN configuration ( BRI Configuration [426]).
[Method Flowchart]
A trunk call is received.

Are any MSNs assigned
in the MSN table?
Yes

Is the MSN found in the
MSN table?
Yes
Does the call have its CLI*
information and is CLI mode
enabled for the time mode?

No

The call is routed to the
operator (Intercept
Routing—No Destination).
No
The call is ignored.

No

Yes
CLI works.

Yes

Is the CLI destination
assigned?
No
Is the MSN destination for
the time mode assigned?

No

Yes
The call is routed to the
CLI destination.

The call is routed to the
MSN destination.

The call is routed to the
operator (Intercept
Routing—No Destination).

*: Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution:
If the CLI routing is enabled and the caller's identification number is assigned in the Caller ID
Table, the call will not be routed to the MSN destination, but routed to the CLI destination.

24

Feature Guide

1.1 Incoming Call Features

[Programming Example of MSN Table for ISDN BRI Port 1]
A table can be programmed for each ISDN-BRI port. Each BRI port has 10 MSN locations.
MSN
Name

CLI

MSN Destination

Locat
ion

MSN

01

1234567

A
Company

Enable

Disabl
Disabl
Enable
e
e

101

100

101

100

02

1232468

C
Company

Enable

Disabl Disabl Disabl
e
e
e

102

100

102

100

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

10

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

Day

Lunch Break

Night

Day Lunch Break Night

Note
Tenant number and VPS trunk group number can also be assigned in the MSN table.
Tenant number is used to determine the time mode (day/lunch/break/night) for the
corresponding MSN. VPS trunk group number is used in Voice Mail DPT (Digital)
Integration ( 1.23.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration).
Explanation:
If the MSN "123-4567" is received from BRI port 1:
1. Checks the number in the table.
Matches the number in location 01.
2. Checks the time mode.
In Day mode: CLI is enabled. Route to CLI destination.
In Lunch mode: CLI is disabled. Route to MSN destination, extension 100.

Conditions
•
•

To use this feature, the MSN service must be assigned for a trunk port as the distribution
method ( BRI DIL/DDI/MSN Selection [421]).
MSN Modification
It is possible to modify a received MSN to make it shorter, which may be convenient when
programming the MSN table. Modification method (removed number of digits/added
number) can be programmed on a trunk port basis.
[Modification Example]

Removed number of digits: 6
Added number: 10
Received MSN: 87654321

•

Modified MSN: 876543 21 = 1021
1) Remove the first
6 digits.

2) Add "10".

When using point-to-multipoint configuration with a BRI, do not connect another ISDN
terminal device in parallel with the PBX. As only two channels can be used at one time
with the BRI, the other ISDN terminal device may monopolise both channels.

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.5 Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution

Feature Guide

25

1.1 Incoming Call Features

2.2.4 Time Service

26

Feature Guide

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.1.5

Calling Line Identification (CLI) Distribution

Description
Directs an incoming trunk call to a destination when the caller’s identification number (e.g.,
Caller ID) matches the number in the System Speed Dialling Table which is used as the Caller
ID Table. Each Caller ID number (telephone number for each System Speed Dialling number)
can have its own destination.
CLI Feature

Description

Details in

Caller ID (KX-TDA30/KXTDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

Caller’s number is sent from an analogue
trunk.

• 1.17.1 Caller
ID

Calling Line Identification
Presentation (CLIP)

Caller’s number is sent from an ISDN line. • 1.20.1.2
Calling/
Connected
Line
Identification
Presentation
(CLIP/COLP)

Automatic Number
Identification (ANI) (KXTDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

Caller’s number is sent from an E1 or T1
line.

• 1.21.1 E1
Line Service
(KX-TDA100/
KX-TDA200
only)
• 1.22.1 T1
Line Service
(KX-TDA100/
KX-TDA200
only)

CLI always works in conjunction with the following call distribution methods:

a) DIL
b) DID/DDI
c) MSN Ringing Service
Each trunk (for DIL) and the DID/DDI/MSN number can enable or disable the CLI feature for
each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) ( 2.2.4 Time Service).
When the call has its Caller ID and the CLI is enabled for the time mode, the call will be handled
by the CLI method.
[Programming Example of System Speed Dialling Table for CLI]
Location
(System Speed
Dialling No.)

Telephone No.*1

System Speed
Dialling Name*2

CLI Destination

000

901234567890

ABC Company

200

001

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

Feature Guide

27

1.1 Incoming Call Features

System Speed Dialling Number [001]
System Speed Dialling Name [002]

*1:
*2:

Explanation:
If the caller’s number is "0123-456-7890" (The Trunk Access number is disregarded.):
1. Checks the number in the table.
Matches the number in location 000.
2. The call is routed to the CLI destination, extension 200.

Conditions
•

Automatic Caller ID Number Modification
The Caller ID number is used after modification by the Automatic Caller ID Number
Modification. ( 1.17.1 Caller ID)

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL)
1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI)
1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service
1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System

28

Feature Guide

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.1.6

Intercept Routing

Description
Provides automatic redirection of incoming trunk calls. There are two types of Intercept Routing
as follows:
Feature

Description

Intercept Routing—No If a called party does not answer a call within a preprogrammed
Answer (IRNA)
time period (Intercept time) ( Intercept Time [203]), it is
redirected to the preprogrammed destination.
Intercept Routing—
Busy/DND

If a called party is busy or in DND mode, the call is redirected to
the preprogrammed destination.

The available intercept destination is as follows:
Type 1: The destination assigned on the extension port which the original destination joins.
( Extension Intercept Destination [604])
Type 2: The destination assigned on the trunk group which receives the call.
( Trunk Group Intercept Destination [470])
Original Destination

The Available Intercept Destination

Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN
Extension/T1-OPX)

Type 1

PS

Type 1

Incoming Call Distribution Group

Intercept Routing—Overflow in an Incoming Call
Distribution Group works ( 1.2.2.5 Overflow
Feature). The overflow destination is assigned on
the incoming call distribution group which the
original destination joins ( Destination for
Overflow Time Expiration [625]).

PS Ring Group

Type 2

VM Group (DTMF/DPT)

Type 2

External Pager (TAFAS)

Type 2

DISA

Type 2*

Analogue/ISDN Remote
Maintenance

Not available

Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.

Not available

Trunk Group Access no. +
Trunk Group no. + Phone no.

Not available

Other PBX Extension (TIE with no
PBX Code)

Not available

Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX
Code)

Not available

Feature Guide

29

1.1 Incoming Call Features

*: This is applied only when a trunk call arrives on a DISA line but the line is busy at that time.
Once the call reaches the destination extension by using the DISA feature, the Intercept
Routing feature of the extension works.
Each of them can have different intercept destinations for each time mode (day/lunch/break/
night) ( 2.2.4 Time Service).
[Available Intercept Destination]
Intercept Destination

Availability

Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX)
PS
Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
VM Group (DTMF/DPT)
External Pager (TAFAS)
DISA
Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance
Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.
Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.
Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)
Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)

Conditions
•

Intercept Routing—Busy/DND on/off
Each Intercept Routing—Busy and Intercept Routing—DND can be enabled or disabled
through system programming.
If disabled, one of the following is activated depending on the trunk card type which a call
arrives through:

a) LCOT or T1 (LCOT/GCOT) Card: The incoming trunk call will ring at the original
destination while the caller hears a ringback tone.

b) Other Trunk Cards: A busy tone will be sent to the caller.
•

If the intercept destination cannot receive the call:

a) Intercept Routing—No Answer: Intercept timer will restart at the original
destination, until the call is answered.

b) Intercept Routing—Busy/DND: The call will be sent back to the original destination

•

30

Feature Guide

when the call arrives through the LCOT or T1 (LCOT/GCOT) card. When the call
arrives through other trunk cards the caller will hear a busy tone.
Idle Extension Hunting
If an extension is a member of an idle extension hunting group, calls to that extension will
not be redirected by Intercept Routing—Busy/DND. If the extension is busy or in DND
mode, calls to that extension will be redirected to the next extension in the idle extension
hunting group.

1.1 Incoming Call Features

Feature Guide References
1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)

Feature Guide

31

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.1.7

Intercept Routing—No Destination

Description
Provides automatic redirection of an incoming trunk call which does not have a destination
assigned. The intercept destination is an operator (tenant/PBX) ( Operator Assignment [006]
*For PBX operator only).

Conditions
•

•
•

Intercept Routing—No Destination on/off
The Intercept Routing—No Destination feature can be enabled or disabled through system
programming.
If disabled, reorder tone will be sent to the caller. However, the Intercept Routing—No
Destination feature always works for calls through the LCOT or T1 (LCOT/GCOT) card
even when disabled.
If an operator (tenant/PBX) is not assigned:
The lowest jack numbered extension will be the intercept destination.
Intercept Routing—No Destination also applies to:
Calls from doorphones.

Feature Guide References
2.2.5 Operator Features

32

Feature Guide

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.2
1.1.2.1

Internal Call Features
Internal Call Features—SUMMARY

Description
The following incoming calls reach their destination:
Feature

Description

Details in

Intercom Call

A call from one extension to another.

• 1.5.3
Intercom Call

Doorphone Call

When a call from a doorphone reaches its destination,
the recipient can talk to the visitor.

• 1.16.1
Doorphone
Call

[Available Destination]
The destinations of doorphone calls can be assigned for each time mode (day/lunch/break/
night) ( 2.2.4 Time Service) on a doorphone port basis ( Doorphone Call Destination
[720]).
Calling from
Destination
Extension

Doorphone

Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX)
PS
Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
VM Group (DTMF/DPT)
External Pager (TAFAS)
DISA
Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance
Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.
Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.
Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)
Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)
: Available

Feature Guide

33

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.2.2

Internal Call Block

Description
Internal calls can be restricted on a COS basis. Each COS of the caller can enable or disable
this feature for each COS of the called party.
[Programming Example]
Called Party
Caller
COS 1

COS 2

COS 3

...

:

:

:

:

COS 1
COS 2
COS 3
:
: Block
Explanation:
a) COS 1 can make calls to all extensions.
b) COS 2 can make calls to COS 1 only. (COS 2 cannot make calls to COS 2.)
c) COS 3 can make calls to COS 3 only.
COS 1

Extn. 100

Extn. 101

COS 2

Extn. 102

COS 3

Extn. 103

Extn. 104

Extn. 105

Extn. 106

Conditions
•
•

34

Feature Guide

Restricted extension numbers cannot be the parameter of the feature settings (e.g.,
Walking Extension).
All extensions can make an Operator Call ( 2.2.5 Operator Features) regardless of the
Internal Call Block.

1.1 Incoming Call Features

•

This feature can also restrict calling a doorphone from an extension on a COS of the
extension and a COS of the doorphone port basis. Each doorphone port can be assigned
a COS. ( 1.16.1 Doorphone Call)

Feature Guide

35

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.3
1.1.3.1

Incoming Call Indication Features
Incoming Call Indication Features—SUMMARY

Description
Incoming calls are indicated by various methods as follows:
Type

36

Feature

Description

Details in

Ring Tone

Ring Tone
Pattern
Selection

A telephone rings when receiving a call. The • 1.1.3.2
ring tone patterns can be changed for each Ring Tone
incoming call type.
Pattern
Selection

Voice-calling

Alternate
Receiving—
Ring/Voice

A PT user can select to receive intercom
calls by ring tone or by voice, through
personal programming.

LED
(LED: Light
Emitting
Diode)

LED Indication The light shows line conditions with a variety • 1.19.3
of light patterns.
LED
Indication

Display
(Caller’s
Information)

Display
Information

The display shows the caller’s information.

• 1.5.3
Intercom
Call

• 1.19.4
Display
Information

External Pager Trunk Answer
from Any
Station
(TAFAS)

The external pager sends a ring tone when • 1.16.3
receiving a call.
Trunk
Answer
From Any
Station
(TAFAS)

Tone/Voice
during a
Conversation

A busy extension hears a tone, or voice from • 1.1.3.3
the handset/built-in speaker indicating that Call Waiting
another incoming call is waiting.

Feature Guide

Call Waiting

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.3.2

Ring Tone Pattern Selection

Description
A ring tone pattern can be selected for each incoming call type on a Ring Tone Pattern Table
basis, which can be assigned for each extension.
[Ring Tone Patterns]
1 280 ms
Single
Double
Triple
S-Double

[Programming Example of Ring Tone Pattern Table]
There are a specified number of programmable tables each of which allows the assignment of
ring tone patterns for the following incoming call types:
For trunk calls (including trunk call hold recalls) and doorphone calls, select ring tone patterns
on a trunk group or a doorphone port basis.

Intercom
Table
Call/Hold
No.
Recall

Trunk Call/Hold
Recall
TRG1

TRG2

Doorphone Call

...

Port 1

1

Double

Single

Single

2

Single

Double

Double

:

:

:

:

:

:

Port 2

...

:

:

Timed
Call
LCS
Reminder Back

:

:

:

Each extension can select one of the tables.

Conditions
•

"PT Ring off Setting" can be enabled or disabled through system programming. If
disabled, PT users cannot set the ring off.

Feature Guide

37

1.1 Incoming Call Features

1.1.3.3

Call Waiting

Description
Used to inform a busy extension that another incoming call is waiting. The busy extension user
can answer the second call by disconnecting the current call or placing it on hold.
The following notification method can be assigned for each extension depending on the call
waiting and the telephone type:

a)
b)
c)
d)

Call Waiting Tone: Tone from the handset or built-in speaker
OHCA: Voice from the built-in speaker
Whisper OHCA: Voice from the handset
Off: No notification.
Notification Method
Call Type
DPT

Other Telephone

Intercom Call

Call Waiting tone/OHCA/ Call Waiting tone/Off
Whisper OHCA/Off

Trunk Call*

Call Waiting tone/Off

*: Including a doorphone call, call via an incoming call distribution group, and a transferred
trunk call from another extension.

This feature is also known as Busy Station Signalling (BSS).

Conditions
•
•
•

•

•

38

Feature Guide

Call Waiting call for an extension in a VM group (DPT/DTMF) is not available.
Data Line Security
Setting Data Line Security cancels the Call Waiting setting. ( 1.10.5 Data Line Security)
Call Waiting Tone
A PT user can hear different Call Waiting tones for trunk call and intercom call if "Tone 2"
has been selected through personal programming (Call Waiting Tone Type Selection). If
"Tone 1" has been selected, the same Call Waiting tone will be heard for both trunk call
and intercom call.
All Call Waiting tone patterns have a default ( 4.2.1 Tones/Ring Tones).
Caller Information
With the Call Waiting tone, the caller’s information flashes on the display for five seconds
at 15-second intervals.
Call Waiting from the Telephone Company
Besides the Call Waiting service within the PBX, the Call Waiting tone offered by an
analogue line from your telephone company informs the extension user of another
incoming trunk call that is waiting. He can answer the second call by disconnecting the
current call or placing it on hold. For details, consult your telephone company.
Call Waiting Caller ID (Visual Caller ID) (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only):
With the Call Waiting tone offered by an analogue line from the telephone company, the
Caller ID number can be received and flash on the display twice for five seconds at 15second intervals.

1.1 Incoming Call Features

Feature Guide References
1.7.4 Second Call Notification to Busy Extension

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.4 Answering Call Waiting
1.7.3 Receiving Call Waiting (Call Waiting/Off-hook Call Announcement [OHCA]/Whisper
OHCA)
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

Feature Guide

39

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2

Receiving Group Features

1.2.1

Idle Extension Hunting

Description
If a called extension is busy or in DND mode, Idle Extension Hunting redirects the incoming call
to an idle member of the same idle extension hunting group, which can be programmed
through system programming ( Idle Extension Hunting Group Member [681]). Idle
extensions are automatically searched according to a preprogrammed hunting type ( Idle
Extension Hunting Type [680]).
This feature is also known as Station Hunting.
Type
Circular Hunting

Description
An idle extension is searched for in the order specified in the idle
extension hunting group in a circular way.
Incoming call

Busy
Extn.

Extn.

Extn.

Extn.

Assigned order

Terminated Hunting An idle extension is searched for in the order specified in the idle
extension hunting group until reaching the last assigned extension.
Incoming call

Extn.

Busy
Extn.

Extn.

Extn.

Assigned order

Conditions
•
•

40

Feature Guide

Idle Extension Hunting applies to:
Intercom, trunk, and doorphone calls to a single destination.
An extension user can belong to only one idle extension hunting group.

1.2 Receiving Group Features

•

If all the searched extensions are busy:
The PBX redirects the call to an overflow destination which can be assigned for each idle
extension hunting group and each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) ( 2.2.4 Time
Service).
[Available Destination]
Destination

Availability

Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX)
PS
Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
VM Group (DTMF/DPT)
External Pager (TAFAS)
DISA
Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance
Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.
Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.
Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)
Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)
•

FWD/DND Mode
While searching for an idle extension within an idle extension hunting group, any extension
which has set FWD—All Calls or DND feature will be skipped, and the call will go to the
next extension in the group.

Feature Guide References
1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)

Feature Guide

41

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2.2
1.2.2.1

Incoming Call Distribution Group Features
Incoming Call Distribution Group Features—SUMMARY

Description
An incoming call distribution group is a group of extensions programmed through system
programming ( Incoming Call Distribution Group Member [620]). An incoming call
distribution group receives calls directed to the group. Each incoming call distribution group
has a floating extension number.
Incoming calls directed to an incoming call distribution group are distributed to the member
extensions in the group using a distribution method. When a preprogrammed number of
extensions in the group are busy, the incoming calls can wait in a queue.
Each incoming call distribution group and member extensions can be programmed as desired
to handle incoming calls. Calls to the group can be monitored by an extension assigned as a
supervisor (supervisor extension).

Programming Item Example for Incoming Call Distribution Group 1 with
Diagram
A through F in the table are described in the following diagram.
A

B

Group
No.
1
2
3
:
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
*5:
*6:
*7:
*8:
*9:

42

Feature Guide

C
Distribution Max. No. of
Busy
Method*3
Extensions*4
Sales
Ring
3
Engineering UCD
Max.

Floating Group
Extn. No.*1 Name*2
290
291

D
Queuing
Call
Capacity*5
5
11

E

F

Hurry-up Overflow Overflow Destination*8
... ... Night
Level*6 Time*7
Day
... ... 100
100
3
60
... ... 200
200
8
90

Tenant
No.*9
1
5

Incoming Call Distribution Group Floating Extension Number [622]
Incoming Call Distribution Group Name [623]
Incoming Call Distribution Group Distribution Method [624]
Maximum Number of Agents [632]
Queuing Call Capacity [628]
Queuing Hurry-up Level [629]
Overflow Time [626]
Destination for Overflow Time Expiration [625]/Destination When All Busy [627]
Tenant number is required to determine the time mode (day/lunch/break/night) (
2.2.4 Time Service) and the music source (for Music on Hold) for each group.

1.2 Receiving Group Features

Calls arriving at incoming call
distribution group 1.

9
8

F Overflow Feature

a) Sends a busy tone (Busy on Busy), or
b) Redirects to the overflow destination.

7
6

D Queuing Feature

5

Five calls are
waiting in a queue.

4
3

B Group Call Distribution

Calls are distributed by the
assigned method.
(Only three extensions
[agents] can answer the
call for C Busy on Busy.)

2
1

E Manual Queue Redirection *10

The longest waiting call in a queue
can be redirected to the overflow
destination by pressing the Hurry-up
button. The button shows the Hurryup status.

Supervisor Extension*11
Extn.
100

Extn.
101

Monitors or controls the
incoming call distribution
group status.

*10:
*11:
*12:

Extn.
102

Extn.
103

Extn.
104

A Incoming Call

Extn.
105
Log-in

Extn.
105
Log-out *12

Distribution Group 1
(Floating extension no.: 290,
Name: Sales)

1.2.2.3 Queuing Feature
1.2.2.7 Supervisory Feature
1.2.2.6 Log-in/Log-out

1. Group Call Distribution [

1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution]
Incoming calls are distributed using one of the following methods:
Distribution Method

Description

Uniform Call
Distribution (UCD)

Calls go to a different extension uniformly each time a call
is received.

Priority Hunting

An idle extension is searched in the specified order.

Ring

All extensions in the incoming call distribution group ring
simultaneously.

2. Queuing Feature [

1.2.2.3 Queuing Feature]
If a preprogrammed numbers of extensions in an incoming call distribution group are busy,
a preprogrammed number of additional calls can wait in a queue.
While calls are waiting in the queue, an outgoing message (OGM) or Music on Hold can
be sent to the waiting callers.

3. VIP Call [

1.2.2.4 VIP Call]
It is possible to assign a priority to incoming call distribution groups so that an incoming

Feature Guide

43

1.2 Receiving Group Features

call can be received from the groups in priority order.

4. Overflow Feature [

1.2.2.5 Overflow Feature]
A call is redirected to a preprogrammed destination when it cannot be answered or queued
(Intercept Routing—Overflow in an Incoming Call Distribution Group). It is also
possible to send a busy tone (Busy on Busy) or disconnect the line.

5. Incoming Call Distribution Group Controlling Feature
Feature

Description

Details in

Log-in/Log-out

Member extensions can join the group to • 1.2.2.6 Loghandle calls (Log-in) or leave the group in/Log-out
for a break (Log-out).
They can leave the group temporarily
when they are away from their desks, to
prevent calls being sent to their
extensions.

Supervisory Incoming
Feature
Call Queue
Monitor

The supervisor extension can monitor
various information about the incoming
calls for each incoming call distribution
group on his display.

Log-in/Logout Monitor
and Remote
Control

• 1.2.2.7
Supervisory
Feature

Monitor: The supervisor extension can
monitor the log-in/log-out status of the
group members.
Remote Control: The supervisor
extension can change the status of the
members.

Conditions
•
•

•
•

44

Feature Guide

One extension can belong to multiple incoming call distribution groups.
ICD Group button
An Incoming Call Distribution (ICD) Group button can be assigned on a flexible button for
each incoming call distribution group. It receives the incoming calls to the group.
One extension can have more than one ICD Group button of the same or different
incoming call distribution groups (Multiple ICD Group). If all ICD Group buttons in the
same incoming call distribution group are occupied, the next incoming call will be held in
a queue or will overflow. If the ICD Group button is not assigned, incoming calls will arrive
at the INTERCOM or CO button.
Even though an extension can have an ICD Group button for an incoming call distribution
group that the extension has not been programmed to be included through system
programming ( Incoming Call Distribution Group Member [620]), the ICD Group button
will not receive calls to that group.
Group FWD
The FWD feature can be assigned on an incoming call distribution group basis.
COS for Incoming Call Distribution Groups
Each incoming call distribution group is assigned a COS number. Group FWD to an
outside party can be enabled or disabled for each COS. The COS for incoming call
distribution groups is also used for the Internal Call Block feature; when an extension user
calls an incoming call distribution group, the PBX checks the COS of the calling extension
against the COS of the incoming call distribution group ( 1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block).

1.2 Receiving Group Features

Feature Guide References
1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

Feature Guide

45

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2.2.2

Group Call Distribution

Description
The Incoming calls directed to an incoming call distribution group are distributed to the member
extensions using the distribution method until a preprogrammed number of extensions (agents)
( Maximum Number of Agents [632]) are available to accept a call. When incoming calls
exceed the number, the calls enter a queue ( 1.2.2.3 Queuing Feature).

1. Distribution Method
There are three distribution methods which can be assigned to each incoming call
distribution group ( Incoming Call Distribution Group Distribution Method [624]).
Distribution
Method
Uniform Call
Distribution
(UCD)

Description
Calls go to a different extension uniformly each time a call is
received. Extensions are hunted in a circular way in the
preprogrammed order for the group, starting at the extension after
the extension which received the last call.

Received
the last call.

Extn.
D

Extn.
C

Extn.
B

Extn.
A

Starts searching from
extn. B. (Skips extn. A.)

Priority Hunting An idle extension is searched for using the preprogrammed order
for the group.
1st Priority

2nd Priority 3rd ....
Extn.
B

Extn.
A

Extn.
C

Extn.
D

Always starts searching from
the first assigned extension.

Ring

All extensions in the group ring simultaneously.
Delayed Ringing:
Delayed ringing or no ringing can be programmed for each
extension in the group ( Incoming Call Distribution Group
Delayed Ringing [621]). The call can be answered by pressing the
flashing button even if no ring or a delayed time is set.

Extn.
A

Extn.
B

Extn.
C

Rings immediately simultaneously.

46

Feature Guide

Extn.
D

Delayed Ringing:
Rings after a
specified time delay.

1.2 Receiving Group Features

2. Call Waiting for Incoming Call Distribution Group (Group Call Waiting)
When there are no available extensions in an incoming call distribution group, the group
members can receive the Call Waiting tone. To use this feature:
•
Select the Group Call Waiting mode through system programming. This determines
the distribution method for waiting calls.
•
Member extensions must assign the Call Waiting mode individually, or they will not be
notified. ( 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting)
[How the Group Call Waiting Feature Activates]
Programming Conditions

Result

Group Call
Group Call
Waiting Mode Distribution Method
Distribution
UCD
Priority Hunting
Ring
All
UCD/Priority Hunting/
Ring

Group Call Waiting
Capable
Distribution Method
Telephone
PT/PS with idle
UCD
ICD Group button
Priority Hunting
Any telephone
Not available*
Ring

*: Incoming calls enter the queue immediately. Member extensions do not receive the
Call Waiting tone.
[Example]
• Group Call Waiting mode: All
• Group call distribution method

for idle extensions: UCD

All extensions hear the Call
Waiting tone (Ring).

[ICD Group Button for Group Call Waiting]
The way that the Group Call Waiting feature works depends on the Group Call Waiting
Distribution method as follows:

a) Ring: The Group Call Waiting feature activates for all busy member extensions
(even when the extensions do not have ICD Group buttons) simultaneously for
only one incoming call — additional calls will wait in a queue.

b) UCD/Priority Hunting: The Group Call Waiting feature activates on an idle ICD
Group button located on busy member extensions in a certain order. (This order
depends on the type: UCD or Priority Hunting.) Calls will arrive at idle buttons
until all ICD Group buttons are occupied — additional calls will wait in a queue.
Note
In the method b), if an extension has one or more ICD Group buttons for an
incoming call distribution group and all the ICD Group buttons on the extension
are occupied, the Group Call Waiting feature for the group will not work at the
extension.

Feature Guide

47

1.2 Receiving Group Features

Incoming Call
Distribution
Group 1
(Floating
extension
no.: 200)

3
2

Incoming Call
Distribution
Group 2
(Floating
extension
no.: 300)

1

ICD Group 200 (Call Waiting)
ICD Group 200 (Call Waiting)
ICD Group 300 (Answering the Call)

3. No Reply Redirection (UCD or Priority Hunting Method)
If a call received at a member extension is not answered within a preprogrammed time
period (No Answer time), the call will be redirected to the next member extension. If there
is no idle group member, the call queues at target extension until a group member
becomes available.

Conditions
•

•

48

Feature Guide

FWD/DND Extension
System programming for each incoming call distribution group is required to skip or ring
the extension which has FWD or DND feature set. If it rings, the FWD/DND settings are
ignored. ( 1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND))
Group Call Waiting feature cannot be used with the VIP Call feature ( 1.2.2.4 VIP Call)
and/or Wrap-up feature ( 1.2.2.6 Log-in/Log-out). Because to use the VIP Call feature
and/or Wrap-up feature, Call Waiting mode on each extension should be off.

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2.2.3

Queuing Feature

Description
When a preprogrammed number of extensions ( Maximum Number of Agents [632]) in an
incoming call distribution group are busy, additional incoming calls can wait in a queue. The
number of calls which can be in the waiting queue is programmable ( Queuing Call Capacity
[628]).
While calls are waiting in the queue, the calls are handled by the Queuing Time Table (
Queuing Time Table [630]), which can be assigned for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night)
( 2.2.4 Time Service). Each Queuing Time Table has a specified number of sequences. The
following procedures are provided to make up a Queuing Time Table:
[Procedure Table]
Command

Description

Condition

OGM a

An outgoing message (OGM) a After the outgoing message (OGM),
(01–64 [with the KX-TDA100/KX- Music on Hold will be sent and redirects
TDA200] or 01–32 [with the KX- to the next sequence.
TDA15/KX-TDA30]) is sent to the
caller.

b×5s

Puts the caller in the waiting
If an outgoing message (OGM) has not
queue for b (01–16) × 5 seconds. been sent to the caller, the caller hears
a ringback tone.
If an outgoing message (OGM) has
been sent to the caller, the caller hears
Music on Hold.

Sequence c

Redirects to sequence c (01–16). None

Overflow

Redirects to overflow destination. None

Disconnect

Disconnects the line.

None

None
Redirects to the next sequence.
(No command)

If assigned on sequence 01, the
Queuing Time Table will not be
activated.

[Programming Example of Queuing Time Table]
Queuing
Sequence*1
Time
Sequence Sequence Sequence Sequence
Table
01
02
03
04
No.
01

OGM 01

6×5s

OGM 03

Overflow

:

:

:

:

...

Sequence
16*2

:

:

02
03
:
*1:
*2:

Sequences in Queuing Time Table [631]
The call will be disconnected if the destination is not determined after sequence 16.

Feature Guide

49

1.2 Receiving Group Features

Explanation for Queuing Time Table 01:
Queuing Time Table 01
Sequence 01

The call
queues.

Sequence 02

OGM 01 is sent.
Thank you for
calling Panasonic.
The department you
are calling is busy.
Please hold the line.
We will answer your
call shortly.

Music on Hold
is sent for 30
seconds.

Sequence 03
OGM 03 is sent.
We are sorry to
keep you holding.
The department
is still busy. We
are transferring
you to the
operator.

Sequence 04
Redirects to
the overflow
destination.

Overflow
destination
answers.

The call is connected to the member
extension as soon as the extension
becomes available.

Conditions
•

•

•

If the call is transferred to the incoming call distribution group and is handled by the
Queuing Time Table:
Transfer Recall will not occur even if the Transfer Recall time expires.
Manual Queue Redirection
It is possible to redirect the longest waiting call in a queue to the overflow destination by
pressing the Hurry-up button. (When the call is already ringing on any extension, the call
is not redirected.)
This feature is also known as Hurry-up Transfer.
Hurry-up Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Hurry-up button. The number of calls queuing
before Manual Queue Redirection may be performed is programmable ( Queuing Hurryup Level [629]). The button shows the current status as follows:
Light Pattern

Calls in the Waiting Queue

Off

No queued call

Red on

At or under the assigned number for Hurry-up

Rapid red flashing

Over the assigned number for Hurry-up

Feature Guide References
1.2.2.5 Overflow Feature
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.8.3 Forwarding a Waiting Call (Manual Queue Redirection)

50

Feature Guide

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2.2.4

VIP Call

Description
It is possible to assign a priority to incoming call distribution groups. If an extension belongs to
multiple groups and the extension becomes idle, queuing calls in the groups will be distributed
to the extension in priority order.
Each incoming call distribution group can enable or disable the VIP Call mode. When multiple
groups enable the VIP Call mode, the incoming call distribution group with the lowest
numbered group has the highest priority. When multiple groups disable the VIP Call mode,
queuing calls are distributed to extensions uniformly.
[Example]
In the call centre, incoming call distribution groups 1 and 3 enable the VIP Call mode, while
incoming call distribution groups 2 and 4 disable the VIP Call mode.
Calls have been distributed by DIL/DID/DDI/CLI.
(The number in the circle is the queuing order.)

Incoming Call
Distribution
Group 1
(for VIP)

6
1

Incoming Call
Distribution
Group 2
(for general
customers)

Incoming Call
Distribution
Group 3
(for special
customers)

5
3

3rd
Priority

1st
Priority
Extn.
101

Extn.
102

4
2

2nd
Priority

Incoming Call
Distribution
Group 4
(for general
customers)

8
7

3rd
Priority

Extn.
103
Distribution order: 1

6

2

4

From: Group 1 Group 3

3

7

5

8

Groups 2 and 4

Feature Guide

51

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2.2.5

Overflow Feature

Description
When waiting calls exceed the waiting queue capacity ( Queuing Call Capacity [628]), they
may be redirected to a preprogrammed destination or a busy tone may be sent to the callers
by the following features:
1) Intercept Routing—Overflow in an Incoming Call Distribution Group
2) Busy on Busy

1. Intercept Routing—Overflow in an Incoming Call Distribution Group
The Intercept Routing—Overflow in an Incoming Call Distribution Group works in one of
following conditions:

a)
b)
c)
d)
e)

There is no space in the waiting queue.
The Queuing Time Table is not assigned and there are no extensions logged-in.
An Overflow command is assigned to the Queuing Time Table.
The Overflow time (

Overflow Time [626]) expires.

Manual Queue Redirection is performed.

[Available Destination]
The overflow destinations can be assigned for each incoming call distribution group and
each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) ( 2.2.4 Time Service). The two different
destinations can be assigned, one for the a) and b) ( Destination When All Busy [627]),
and one for c), d), and e) ( Destination for Overflow Time Expiration [625]).
Destination
Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX)
PS
Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
VM Group (DTMF/DPT)
External Pager (TAFAS)
DISA
Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance
Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.
Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.
Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)
Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)

52

Feature Guide

Availability

1.2 Receiving Group Features

2. Busy on Busy
The Busy on Busy feature works when the destination for the Intercept Routing—Overflow
in an Incoming Call Distribution Group feature is not assigned in one of the following
conditions:

a) There is no space in the Waiting queue.
b) The Queuing Time Table is not assigned and there are no extensions logged-in.
[Example of a)]
When the answering agent number ( Maximum Number of Agents [632]) is "2", and the
queuing call number ( Queuing Call Capacity [628]) is "0":
There are five assistants in the shop. If two of them are engaged on the phone, the next
caller will hear a busy tone to prevent the caller from thinking that there is no one in the
shop or that the shop is closed.

Conditions
[Intercept Routing—Overflow in an Incoming Call Distribution Group]
•

If the Overflow time expires, and the overflow destination is unavailable:

a) If the trunk call arrives through the LCOT or T1 (LCOT/GCOT) card: (1) The line is
disconnected when the call was once in a queue and an outgoing message (OGM)
was sent to the call, or when the call reached an incoming call distribution group by
using the DISA feature ( 1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA)). (2) Except
for the above, redirection is ignored and the Overflow timer activates again.

b) If the call arrives through the other cards: Redirection is ignored and the Overflow
timer activates again.

[Busy on Busy]
•

If a trunk call arrives through the LCOT or T1 (LCOT/GCOT) card, a busy tone will not be
sent to the caller.

Feature Guide References
1.2.2.3 Queuing Feature

Feature Guide

53

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2.2.6

Log-in/Log-out

Description
Incoming call distribution group members can join (Log-in) or leave (Log-out) the groups
manually.
They can leave the group temporarily when they are away from their desks, to prevent calls
being sent to their extensions. They can return to the group when they are ready to answer
calls.
Wrap-up:
While logged-in, a member extension can have a preprogrammed time period automatically for
refusing calls after completing the last call (Wrap-up time). While Wrap-up timer is active, calls
to all incoming call distribution groups to which the extension belongs will skip the extension so
that he can make some report or etc.
Wrap-up mode can also be activated manually (Not Ready) by pressing the Wrap-up button.
[Log-in/Log-out and Wrap-up Status Example]

Incoming call

Ready

Log-in

Waiting for a call
Press the
Wrap-up button.

Extn.
101

Extn.
102

Ready

Extn.
103

Extn.
104

Extn.
105

Extn.
106

Answering a call

The Wrap-up
time expires.

Not Ready

Making a report/
temporary break

Ready Not Ready Wrap-up Ready

After
completing
the call

Press the
Wrap-up button.

Wrap-up
Making a report

Extn.
102
Log-out

Conditions
•
•

It is programmable whether the last remaining logged-in extension can log out.
Log-in/Log-out Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Log-in/Log-out button with the following
parameters:
Light Pattern
Parameter

Usage
Red on

No parameter

54

Feature Guide

Used with an ICD Group button, or with a —
floating extension number of an incoming
call distribution group, or with (All).

Off
—

1.2 Receiving Group Features

Light Pattern
Parameter

Usage
Red on

Log-out
Floating extension Used to log-in or log-out from the
specified incoming call distribution group. Status
number of a
specified incoming
call distribution
group
(All)

•

•

•

•

•

Log-in
Status

Used to log-in or log-out from all incoming After Log- After Logcall distribution groups to which you
out
in
belong.
Operation Operation

If an ICD Group button is assigned, it also shows the log-in/log-out status of the
corresponding group. The light pattern is the same as the Log-in/Log-out button which
includes the group number.
Wrap-up Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Wrap-up button. It shows the current status as
follows:
Light pattern

•

Off

Status

Slow red flashing

Wrap-up

Red on

Not Ready

Off

Ready (Wrap-up mode cancel)

When a PS in Wireless XDP Parallel Mode completes a call, neither the PS nor its wired
telephone can have Wrap-up time. ( 1.24.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode)
Automatic Log-out
A member extension may be logged-out automatically, if the Unanswered time expires a
preprogrammed number of times consecutively. The number of consecutive unanswered
calls can be assigned for each incoming call distribution group. If the extension is a
member of more than one incoming call distribution group, the unanswered number is
counted across all corresponding incoming call distribution groups. It is possible to return
to the log-in mode manually.
Automatic Log-out feature does not work for the extension in an incoming call distribution
group in Ring distribution method ( 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution).
Log-in/Log-out Monitor
The supervisor extension can monitor and control the log-in/log-out status of the incoming
call distribution group members. ( 1.2.2.7 Supervisory Feature)
Log-in/Log-out Information on SMDR
Log-in/Log-out information can be printed out on SMDR. ( 1.25.1 Station Message
Detail Recording (SMDR))

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.8.1 Leaving an Incoming Call Distribution Group (Log-in/Log-out, Wrap-up)

Feature Guide

55

1.2 Receiving Group Features

1.2.2.7

Supervisory Feature

Description
An extension preprogrammed as a supervisor (supervisor extension) can monitor and control
each member’s status within the incoming call distribution group using a 6-line display PT.
Feature

Description

Incoming Call Queue The supervisor extension can monitor the status of an incoming
Monitor
call distribution group with the display.
Log-in/Log-out
Monitor and Remote
Control

Monitor: The supervisor extension can monitor the log-in/log-out
status of the incoming call distribution group members through the
corresponding DSS button light.
Remote Control: The supervisor extension can change the status
of the members by pressing the corresponding DSS button.

[Example]

31 Jan. 08:13AM FRI
250:Sales Section
Waiting Calls Now :00006
Max. Waiting Time :05'10
EXIT

LOG

--- Date and time
--- Floating extension number/name of incoming call distribution group
--- The number of queuing calls
--- The longest queuing time

SPRVS
Since 29 JAN. 09:10AM --- Monitoring starting date and time
Total Calls
:00996 --- Total number of incoming calls
Overflow Calls
:00131 --- Total number of overflowed calls
Lost Calls
:00039 --- The number of lost calls
Average Waiting
:02'12 --- Average queuing time
EXIT
CLEAR


31 Jan. 08:13AM FRI
250:Sales Section
Waiting Calls Now :00006
Max. Waiting Time :05'10 With
EXIT

Log-in/Log-out Monitor
DSS buttons of the incoming call
distribution group members show
their status.
Light pattern

Status

Status

Light pattern

Green on

Log-in (Ready)

Log-out

Red on

Slow Green Flashing Log-in (Not Ready)

56

Feature Guide

Log-in/Log-out Remote Control
Pressing the button changes
the status as follows:

Red on

Log-out

Off

Extension in another
incoming call distribution
group

Log-in (Ready) Green on

1.2 Receiving Group Features

Conditions
•

Available Extension as a Supervisor Extension

a) One supervisor extension can be assigned for each incoming call distribution group,
but it need not belong to the group.

b) One extension can be the supervisor extension of more than one incoming call
•
•

•

•

distribution group.
Available Paired DSS Console
The KX-T7640, KX-T7440, and KX-T7441 are available for this feature.
Accumulation Value Clear
Accumulation value (total incoming calls/total overflowed calls/lost calls/average queuing
time) can be cleared manually. The date and time of clearing is saved and it is shown on
the display (monitoring starting date and time). When the value exceeds 99999, before
clearing, "****" will be shown.
If a call to an incoming call distribution group is overflowed:
If the display is in idle status, it will change to monitor mode for the corresponding incoming
call distribution group automatically.
If the display is monitoring another incoming call distribution group, it will not change.
Other Features while in Monitor Mode
The supervisor extension can use other features (making calls, pressing the MESSAGE
button, etc.) even while in monitor mode. When each operation is finished, his telephone
returns to the queue monitor display.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.8.2 Monitoring and Controlling the Call Status of an Incoming Call Distribution Group
(Incoming Call Distribution Group Monitor)

Feature Guide

57

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

1.3

Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb
(DND) Features

1.3.1

Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)

1.3.1.1

Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)—
SUMMARY

Description
When an extension user cannot answer calls (e.g., busy, not at the desk), it is possible to
forward or refuse the calls using the following features:
1) Call Forwarding (FWD)
2) Do Not Disturb (DND)

1. FWD
Extensions and incoming call distribution groups can forward their incoming calls to preset
destinations. ( 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD))

2. DND
An extension user can send the tone to let the caller know he is not available. (
Do Not Disturb (DND))

1.3.1.3

Conditions
•

•

•

FWD and DND features apply to:
Intercom calls (including doorphone calls), and trunk calls (including a call from an
extension that placed a trunk call on a consultation hold.)
FWD/DND Button
Both the FWD and DND features for the extension can be customised on a flexible button.
Only one of the features will work at a time.
Multiple types of FWD/DND buttons can be customised on an extension.
Group FWD Button
The FWD feature for the incoming call distribution group can be customised on a flexible
button. Multiple types of Group FWD buttons can be customised on an extension.
[FWD/DND Button and Group FWD Button Types]
Type
FWD/DND for FWD/DND—Internal
Extension
FWD/DND—External
FWD/DND—Both

58

Feature Guide

Description
Works for incoming intercom calls
Works for incoming trunk calls
Works for all incoming calls

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

Type

Description

Group FWD—Internal
FWD for
Incoming Call
Group FWD—External
Distribution
Group
Group FWD—Both

Works for incoming intercom calls
Works for incoming trunk calls
Works for all incoming calls

[Button Status—FWD/DND Button]
The FWD/DND button shows the current status as follows:
Light Pattern

Status (default)

Red on

FWD on

Slow red flashing

DND on

Off

FWD/DND off

The functions assigned to the "on" and "flashing" patterns can be changed through system
programming.
[Button Status—Group FWD Button]
The Group FWD button shows the current status as follows:
Light Pattern

Status (default)

Red on

FWD on

Off

FWD off

[Mode Change]
When either the FWD or DND feature is assigned, pressing the FWD/DND button changes
the on/off setting alternately. When both the features are assigned simultaneously,
pressing the button changes the settings as follows:
FWD

DND

Off

Note
Pressing the FWD/DND button (fixed button) in idle status will produce one of the
following results, selected through system programming:
When in FWD/DND Setting Mode:
Pressing the button will enter personal programming mode for the FWD/DND setting.
When in FWD/DND Cycle Switch Mode:
Pressing the button will cycle the settings as shown above in [Mode Change].

•

A FWD/DND button customised on a flexible button is always in FWD/DND Cycle
Switch mode, and the mode cannot be changed.
When intercom calls are set to be handled differently from trunk calls (forwarding type,
forward destination, DND on/off), we recommend establishing buttons for both FWD/
DND—Internal and FWD/DND—External, and/or Group FWD—Internal and Group
FWD—External, because:

a) the light patterns of the FWD/DND—Both button (including FWD/DND button [fixed
button]) and the Group FWD—Both button will indicate the setting for either trunk calls

Feature Guide

59

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

or intercom calls, but not both.
Note
The FWD and DND icons on a PS display reflect the settings for trunk calls only.

b) pressing the FWD/DND—Both button (including FWD/DND button [fixed button]) or
the Group FWD—Both button will not change the FWD or DND mode for intercom
calls and trunk calls separately.

Feature Guide References
1.19.1 Fixed Buttons
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

60

Feature Guide

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

1.3.1.2

Call Forwarding (FWD)

Description
Extensions and incoming call distribution groups can forward their calls to preset destinations.
The circumstances under which the calls are forwarded are as follows:
Type

Circumstance

All Calls

Any time
Follow Me:
When an extension user fails to set this feature before leaving the
desk, this feature can be set from the destination extension.

Busy

When the extension user’s line is busy.

No Answer

When the extension user does not answer within a preprogrammed
time ( Call Forwarding—No Answer Time [605]).

Busy/No Answer

When the extension user’s line is busy or the user does not answer
within a preprogrammed time ( Call Forwarding—No Answer
Time [605]).

Depending on the type of incoming intercom or trunk calls, it is possible to set different
destination for each.
Intercom Calls
to Extension

Extension

Forwards to
Another Extension

Forwards to
Outside Party

Trunk Calls to
Extension
Available Forwarding Type: All Calls
Busy
No Answer
Busy/No Answer

Incoming Call Distribution Group

Intercom Calls to
Incoming Call
Distribution Group

Forwards to
Another Extension

Trunk Calls to
Incoming Call
Distribution Group

Forwards to
Outside Party
Available Forwarding Type: All Calls

Feature Guide

61

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

[Available Destination]

Destination
Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1OPX)
PS

Availability

Condition for Original
Extension/Incoming Call
Distribution Group
Only available when FWD to
extension is allowed through
COS programming.*

Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group

–

VM Group (DTMF/DPT)

–

External Pager (TAFAS)

–

DISA

Only available for incoming
trunk calls. Incoming
intercom and doorphone
calls cannot be forwarded to
a DISA floating extension
number.

Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance

–

Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.

Only available when FWD to
trunk is allowed through
COS programming.

Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.
Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)

–

Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)

Only available when FWD to
trunk is allowed through
COS programming.

*: If an extension user cannot call certain extensions on a COS basis (
Block), the FWD feature to the extension does NOT work.

1.1.2.2 Internal Call

Conditions
[General]
•

•

•

62

Feature Guide

FWD for Trunk Calls/Intercom Calls
The FWD feature can be set for trunk calls, for intercom calls, or for both of them by the
extension user.
FWD from Incoming Call Distribution Group (Group FWD)
COS programming determines the incoming call distribution groups that can use this
feature.
FWD to Trunk
COS programming determines the extensions or incoming call distribution groups that can
forward calls externally ( Call Forwarding to Trunk [504]).
The original extension’s TRS/Barring and ARS still apply to the forwarded call.

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

•

•

Trunk Call Duration
If a call between an extension user and an outside party, or between two outside parties
is established, the call duration can be restricted by a system timer ( Extension-to-Trunk
Call Duration [472] and Trunk-to-Trunk Call Duration [473]). If the timer expires, the line will
be disconnected. ( 1.10.8 Trunk Call Limitation)
Multiple FWD
Calls can be forwarded up to four times. The following forwarding features are counted as
Multiple FWD:
– FWD—Busy or Busy/No Answer (in case a destination extension is busy), or All
Calls
– Idle Extension Hunting—Overflow
– Intercept Routing—Busy/DND (in case a destination extension is busy or in DND
mode)
– Incoming Call Distribution Group—Overflow
Incoming
call

1

A

2

B

3

C

4

D

5

E

F

Original
destination

In the above illustration, forwarding stops at the extension E. However, forwarding can go
farther in the following cases:
– If a destination extension rings, and then the call is redirected to the forward
destination by the FWD—No Answer or Busy/No Answer feature.
– If a destination extension rings, and then the call is redirected to the intercept
destination by the Intercept Routing—No Answer feature.
– If a call waits in a queue of an incoming call distribution group, and then the call
is redirected to the overflow destination by the Queuing Time Table. ( 1.2.2.3
Queuing Feature)
In the above cases, the forwarding counters reset to zero, and calls can be forwarded up
to four times again from the applicable extension that occurred in the case above.
Incoming
call

1

A

2

B

3

C

Original
destination

•

1

D

2

E

F

FWD—No Answer

Boss & Secretary feature
It is possible to call the original extension from the destination extension regardless of the
forward setting.
Incoming
call

FWD—All Calls

Call or
transfer a call

Boss
(Original)

Secretary
(FWD destination)

Feature Guide

63

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

•

•

Message Waiting
While calls are forwarded, Message Waiting information is not forwarded. The Message
button light turns on at the originally called extension. ( 1.18.1 Message Waiting)
Idle Extension Hunting
Idle Extension Hunting applies to calls forwarded to a busy extension in an idle extension
hunting group.

[All Calls and Busy]
•

If the forward destination is not available to answer a call, this feature is cancelled and the
original destination will ring for the following type of call:
– Doorphone call
– Trunk calls via the LCOT or T1 (LCOT/GCOT) cards

[No Answer and Busy/No Answer]
•

No Answer Time
The number of rings before the call is forwarded is programmable for each extension (
Call Forwarding—No Answer Time [605]).

[Follow Me]
•

This feature is only available when the original extension has disabled the "Deny Remote
Operation by Other Extension" setting on a COS basis.

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing
1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting
1.2.2.5 Overflow Feature

User Manual References
User Manual
1.5.1 Forwarding Calls

64

Feature Guide

1.3 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND) Features

1.3.1.3

Do Not Disturb (DND)

Description
An extension user can make use of the DND feature. If this feature is set, calls will not arrive
at the extension, but arrive at other extension by using the Idle Extension Hunting feature (
1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting) or the Intercept Routing—Busy/DND feature ( 1.1.1.6 Intercept
Routing). When a destination cannot be found, the calling extension will hear the DND tone,
while the calling outside party will hear a busy tone.

Conditions
•

•
•

•

•

•

•

•

DND for Trunk Calls/Intercom Calls
The DND feature can be set for trunk calls, for intercom calls, or for both of them by the
extension user.
DSS button in DND Mode
The DSS button light will turn red if the assigned extension has set DND.
DND Override
An extension in DND mode can be called by other extension users who are allowed to
override DND in their COS ( DND Override [507]).
Paging DND
It is programmable whether the PBX pages extensions in DND mode through system
programming. ( 1.14.1 Paging)
Intercept Routing—Busy/DND
If a call arrives at the extension in DND mode, the call can be redirected to the
preprogrammed destination by the Intercept Routing—Busy/DND feature.
Idle Extension Hunting
While searching for an idle extension within an idle extension hunting group, any extension
which has DND set will be skipped. The call will go to the next extension in the group, not
the Intercept Routing—Busy/DND destination.
If (1) the trunk call via the LCOT or T1 (LCOT/GCOT) card arrives at the extension in DND
mode and (2) the Intercept Routing—Busy/DND destination is not available and (3) there
is no available extension in the idle extension hunting group, then the original extension in
DND mode will ring.
Calls from a doorphone arrive at the extension even when the extension is in DND mode.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer
1.7.2 Refusing Incoming Calls (Do Not Disturb [DND])

Feature Guide

65

1.4 Answering Features

1.4

Answering Features

1.4.1

Answering Features

1.4.1.1

Answering Features—SUMMARY

Description
An extension user can answer incoming calls by the following methods:
Destination
At the own
extension
(PT only)

At another
extension

66

Feature Guide

Feature

Description

Details in

Line
Preference—
Incoming

A user can select the line seized when going • 1.4.1.2
off-hook.
Line
Preference
—Incoming

Direct Onetouch
Answering

A user can answer an incoming call simply
by pressing the flashing button.

Hands-free
Answerback

A user can receive a call automatically and • 1.4.1.4
establish a hands-free conversation.
Hands-free
Answerback

Call Pickup—
Directed/Group

A user can pick up a specified extension’s • 1.4.1.3 Call
call or a call in a specified call pickup group. Pickup

–

1.4 Answering Features

1.4.1.2

Line Preference—Incoming

Description
A PT user can select the method used to answer incoming calls from the following three line
preferences:
Each of these line preferences can be assigned on each extension through personal
programming (Preferred Line Assignment—Incoming).
Type

Description

No Line

Selects a line by pressing the desired Line Access button to answer
an incoming call after you go off-hook.

Prime Line

Answers a call arriving at a Flexible CO or ICD Group button (on
which the "Prime Line" is assigned) simply by going off-hook. This
works even when multiple calls are received simultaneously.

Ringing Line
(default)

Answers the longest ringing call at one’s telephone simply by going
off-hook when multiple calls arrive.

Conditions
[Prime Line]
•

The priority of the incoming call is as follows:
1) The call arriving at a button on which the "Prime Line" is assigned.
2) The call arriving at the INTERCOM button.

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

Feature Guide

67

1.4 Answering Features

1.4.1.3

Call Pickup

Description
An extension user can answer a call ringing at any other extension.
The following types are available:
Type

Picking up Call Type

Directed

A specified extension’s call.

Group

A call within a specified call pickup group.

Call Pickup Deny:
Preventing other extensions from picking up calls ringing at your extension is also possible.

Conditions
•
•

Call Pickup applies to:
Intercom, trunk, and doorphone calls
Internal Call Block
An extension which cannot call certain extensions on a COS basis (
Block) also cannot pick up any calls ringing at those extensions.

1.1.2.2 Internal Call

[Directed Call Pickup]
•

A user can also pick up a specified extension’s call (except an ISDN extension’s call and
broadcasting call) by pressing the corresponding DSS button. COS programming
determines the extensions that can use this feature.
The light pattern of a DSS button for an incoming call to an extension or incoming call
distribution group can be programmed through system programming. Call Pickup is
available only when the DSS button is red flashing.

[Group Call Pickup]
•

A specified number of call pickup groups can be created ( User Groups of a Pickup
Group [650]), each of which consists of user groups. One user group can belong to several
call pickup groups. ( 2.2.2 Group)
[Example]
Call Pickup Group 1

Call Pickup Group 2

Call Pickup Group 3

User Group 1

User Group 2

User Group 3

User Group 4

Extn. 100 Extn. 101

Extn. 102 Extn. 103

Extn. 104 Extn. 105

Extn. 106 Extn. 107

User Manual References
User Manual
1.3.3 Answering a Call Ringing at Another Telephone (Call Pickup)

68

Feature Guide

1.4 Answering Features

1.4.1.4

Hands-free Answerback

Description
A PT user with a speakerphone can talk to a caller without lifting the handset. If the user
receives a call in Hands-free Answerback mode, a hands-free conversation is established in
the following method:
Type

Answering Method

Intercom Call

Established immediately after a beep tone at the called extension
and the caller hears a confirmation tone.

Trunk Call*

Established after a specified number of rings, a called extension
hears a beep tone.

*: Including a call from an extension that placed a trunk call on a consultation hold.

Conditions
•

•
•

•

•

Hands-free Answerback applies to:
Intercom calls and trunk calls, including calls directed to an incoming call distribution group
in UCD or Priority Hunting distribution method. ( 1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution)
Hands-free Answerback for Trunk Calls
System programming is required to use this feature.
Secret Monitor
The beep tone which the called party hears before answering can be eliminated through
system programming.
Alternate Receiving/Calling Mode (Ring/Voice) Override
Hands-free Answerback overrides the Alternate Receiving mode preset on the telephone
and the Alternate Calling mode from the caller.
Hands-free Answerback with Headset
The Hands-free Answerback feature can also be used with a headset.

Feature Guide References
1.5.3 Intercom Call

User Manual References
User Manual
1.3.2 Answering Hands-free (Hands-free Answerback)

Feature Guide

69

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5

Making Call Features

1.5.1

Predialling

Description
A display PT user can check and correct the number to be dialled on-hook. The call will be
initiated after going off-hook.

Conditions
•

Storing the Predialled Number in the Personal Speed Dialling
The predialled number can be stored in the Personal Speed Dialling by pressing the AUTO
DIAL/STORE button. ( 1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System) In this case, the
extension will enter into the personal programming mode automatically so that a name can
be assigned for the stored number.

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

70

Feature Guide

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.2

Automatic Extension Release

Description
After going off-hook, if an extension user fails to dial any digits within a preprogrammed time
period, the user will hear reorder tone. This operation applies to intercom calls only.
This feature is also known as Automatic Station Release.

Conditions
•

•

A PT/PS user hears reorder tone for a preprogrammed time period, and then the PT/PS
goes back to the idle status automatically. However, an SLT user will just hear reorder tone
until he goes on-hook.
This feature works in one of the following cases:
When making an intercom call

a) The first digit has not been dialled within a preprogrammed time period.
b) After a digit is dialled, if subsequent digits are not dialled within a preprogrammed time
period.

Feature Guide

71

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.3

Intercom Call

Description
An extension user can call another extension user.

Conditions
•

•

•
•

•

•

Extension Number/Name Assignment
Extension numbers ( Extension Number [003]) and names ( Extension Name [004])
are assigned to all extensions. The assigned number and name are shown on display PTs
during intercom calls.
DSS Button
It is possible to access another extension with one-touch by pressing the corresponding
Direct Station Selection (DSS) button. A flexible button can be customised as a DSS
button.
Call Directory—Extension Dialling
Display PT users can make a call by selecting stored names on the display.
Alternate Receiving—Ring/Voice
A PT user can select to receive intercom calls by ring tone or by voice, through personal
programming (Alternate Receiving—Ring/Voice). If a user selects voice-calling, the calling
party talks to the user immediately after a confirmation tone. Denying voice-calling can
also be selected.
Alternate Calling—Ring/Voice
A caller can change the called party’s preset call receiving method (ring tone or voice). By
doing so, ring-calling is switched to voice-calling, or vice versa, at the called party. The
called party may deny voice-calling.
Tone after Dialling
After dialling an extension number, a user will hear one of the following:
Type

Description

Ringback Tone

Indicates the called party is being called.

Confirmation Tone

Indicates the called party has set voice-calling.

Busy Tone

Indicates the called party is busy.

DND Tone

Indicates the called party has set DND.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.1 Basic Calling
1.2.6 Alternating the Calling Method (Alternate Calling—Ring/Voice)
1.11.2 Using the Directories
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

72

Feature Guide

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4
1.5.4.1

Trunk Call Features
Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY

Description
An extension user can use the following features when making a trunk call:
Feature

Description

Details in

Emergency Call

A user can dial the preprogrammed emergency • 1.5.4.2 Emergency
numbers regardless of the restrictions imposed Call
on the extension.

Account Code
Entry

A user can enter an account code to identify
outgoing calls for accounting and billing
purposes.

Pulse to Tone
Conversion

A user can temporarily convert the Pulse mode • 1.5.4.4 Dial Type
to DTMF mode to access special services.
Selection

Pause Insertion

A user can insert a preprogrammed Pause time
into a dialling number by pressing the PAUSE
button, or it is automatically inserted between
the user-dialled code (e.g., Host PBX Access
code or Special Carrier Access code) and the
following digits.

• 1.5.4.3 Account Code
Entry

• 1.5.4.6 Pause
Insertion
• 1.5.4.7 Host PBX
Access Code (Access
Code to the Telephone
Company from a Host
PBX)
• 1.5.4.8 Special
Carrier Access Code

Feature Guide

73

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4.2

Emergency Call

Description
An extension user can dial the preprogrammed emergency numbers ( Emergency Number
[304]) after seizing a trunk regardless of the restrictions imposed on the extension.

Conditions
•
•

A specified number of emergency numbers can be stored (some may have default values).
Emergency numbers may be called even when:
– in Account Code—Forced mode ( 1.5.4.3 Account Code Entry)
– in any TRS/Barring levels ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring))
– after the preprogrammed call charge limit is reached ( 1.8.2 Budget
Management)
– in Extension Lock ( 1.8.3 Extension Lock)

•

74

Feature Guide

CLIP Number Notification (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)
When dialling an emergency number, the preassigned CLIP number for the extension will
be sent as a location identification number. ( 1.20.1.2 Calling/Connected Line
Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP))
The CLIP number assigned to the extension will be sent regardless of the settings such
as CLIR or CLIP number assigned to an ISDN port to be used. This feature is only
available when using a PRI (PRI23) line, with E911 compatible services.

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4.3

Account Code Entry

Description
An account code is used to identify outgoing trunk calls for accounting and billing purposes.
The account code is appended to the SMDR call record. Therefore, for example, the firm uses
an account code for each client so that the firm can determine what calls were made for the
client, and can submit a bill to the client according to the client’s account code on the SMDR
call record.
There are two methods of entering account codes as follows:
One of the methods is selected for each extension on a COS basis ( Account Code Mode
[508]).
Mode

Description

Option

A user can enter an account code if needed at any time desired.

Forced

A user must always enter an account code before seizing a trunk so as
not to forget entering the code.

Conditions
•
•

•

•
•
•
•

An account code can be stored into Memory Dialling (e.g., One-touch Dialling).
Account Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Account button. The Account button is used in
place of the feature number for entering an account code. This button is useful because it
can be used at any time, while the feature number entry is allowed only when hearing a
dial tone before seizing a trunk.
Account code entry after receiving a disconnection signal from a trunk must be done while
hearing reorder tone. Otherwise the SMDR call record is output and entry becomes
impossible afterwards.
If the account code is entered more than once, the code entered last is printed out in the
SMDR.
Even in Forced mode, emergency numbers can be dialled out without an account code.
( 1.5.4.2 Emergency Call)
PT users can also enter an account code for incoming trunk calls during a conversation.
Verified Code Entry
To identify who made a trunk call for accounting and billing purpose, a verified code is
used. This code can be used at any extension. ( 1.8.6 Verified Code Entry)

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons
1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.1 Basic Calling

Feature Guide

75

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4.4

Dial Type Selection

Description
The dialling mode (rotary or tone) can be selected for each analogue trunk through system
programming ( LCOT Dialling Mode [410]) regardless of originating extension (under
contract with the telephone company).
There are the following modes:
Mode

Description

DTMF (Dual Tone
Multi-Frequency)

The dialling signal from an extension is converted to tone dialling.
DTMF signals are transmitted to the trunk.

Pulse Dial (Rotary)

The dialling signal from an extension is converted to rotary dialling.
Rotary pulses are transmitted to the trunk.

Conditions
•

•
•

76

Feature Guide

Pulse to Tone Conversion
It is possible for an extension user to temporarily convert the Pulse mode to DTMF mode
so that the user can access special services such as computer-accessed long distance
calling or voice mail services. To convert to the DTMF mode, wait for a preprogrammed
time period (Default: 5 seconds) after the trunk is connected, or press . This feature
works only on trunks set to Pulse mode. DTMF mode cannot be changed to Pulse mode.
It is possible to select a pulse rate for the trunk port which has been set to Pulse mode (
LCOT Pulse Rate [411]). There are two pulse rates: Low (10 pps) and High (20 pps).
It is possible to assign the minimum duration of the DTMF signal sent to the trunk port
which has been set to DTMF mode ( LCOT DTMF Minimum Duration [412]).

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4.5

Reverse Circuit

Description
The circuit in the PBX can detect the reverse signal from the telephone company when an
extension user is trying to make a trunk call. This detects the start (a called party goes offhook) and end (the called party goes on-hook) of an outgoing trunk call. When an trunk call is
received, the circuit can also detect the reverse signal after an outside caller goes on-hook.
The duration of call can be verified on SMDR using this feature ( 1.25.1 Station Message
Detail Recording (SMDR)).
It is possible to select whether the PBX detects the reverse signal for outgoing trunk calls only,
or for both outgoing and incoming trunk calls, or for no trunk call (disable the detection) through
system programming ( LCOT Reverse Circuit [415]).

Feature Guide

77

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4.6

Pause Insertion

Description
A preprogrammed Pause time ( LCOT Pause Time [416]) will be inserted manually or
automatically.
Manual Insertion: Pressing the PAUSE button.
Automatic Pause Insertion: A pause will be automatically inserted between the user-dialled
codes below and the following digits.

a) Host PBX Access code (

1.5.4.7 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the
Telephone Company from a Host PBX))

b) Special Carrier Access code ( 1.5.4.8 Special Carrier Access Code)
c) Second Dial Tone Waiting code

Conditions
•
•
•
•

78

Feature Guide

The Pause time is programmable for each trunk.
Pause can be stored in Memory Dialling.
Pressing the PAUSE button while dialling a number inserts a pause for a preprogrammed
time period.
When a preprogrammed Second Dial Tone Waiting code is dialled after seizing a trunk,
pauses are inserted a preprogrammed number of times after the code.

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4.7

Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone
Company from a Host PBX)

Description
This PBX can be installed behind an existing host PBX. This is performed by connecting
extension ports of the host PBX to trunk ports of this PBX. A Host PBX Access code assigned
through system programming ( Host PBX Access Code [471]) is required to access the
telephone company from the host PBX. The Trunk Access number of the host PBX should be
stored as a Host PBX Access code on a trunk group of this PBX basis.
A preprogrammed Pause time ( LCOT Pause Time [416]) will be automatically inserted
between the user-dialled Host PBX Access code and the following digits. ( 1.5.4.6 Pause
Insertion)
[Example]

Telephone Company

Host PBX
Access Code: 0

Host PBX

Outside Party
(01-23-4567)

Idle Line
Access No.: 9

Extn. 101

Extn. 102
Dials "0-01-23-4567".

TRG1

Host PBX
Access Code

PBX

Telephone
No.

Dials "9-0-01-23-4567".
Idle Line
Access No.

Telephone No.
Host PBX
Access Code

Dials "9-101".
Idle Line
Access No.
Extn. No.
of the Host PBX

Note: "0" should be assigned as a Host PBX Access code for trunk group (TRG) 1 of this PBX.

Feature Guide

79

1.5 Making Call Features

Conditions
•

•

•

TRS/Barring
TRS/Barring checks only the dialled telephone number excluding the Host PBX Access
code when accessing the telephone company through the host PBX. ( 1.8.1 Toll
Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring))
SMDR
The dialled number including the Host PBX Access code can be recorded on the SMDR
when accessing the telephone company through the host PBX.
To record on the SMDR only long distance calls (not local calls) originated via the specific
trunk group, assign the long distance call code as a Host PBX Access code to the trunk
group.

Feature Guide References
1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)

80

Feature Guide

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.4.8

Special Carrier Access Code

Description
If the PBX has access to multiple telephone companies, a Special Carrier Access code
assigned through system programming ( Special Carrier Access Code [303]) is required
every time when a trunk call is made.
A preprogrammed Pause time ( LCOT Pause Time [416]) will be automatically inserted
between the user-dialled Special Carrier Access code and the following digits. ( 1.5.4.6
Pause Insertion)

Conditions
•

•

TRS/Barring
TRS/Barring checks only the dialled telephone number excluding the Special Carrier
Access code. ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring))
If this PBX is installed behind an existing host PBX:
A Special Carrier Access code and a Host PBX Access code should be assigned
separately: these codes cannot be assigned together as one code. ( 1.5.4.7 Host PBX
Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX))

Feature Guide

81

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.5
1.5.5.1

Seizing a Line Features
Seizing a Line Features—SUMMARY

Description
An extension user can select the line seized for making calls by the following methods:
Feature

82

Description

Details in

Line Preference— A user can select the line seized when going
Outgoing
off-hook.

• 1.5.5.2 Line
Preference—
Outgoing

Trunk Access

• 1.5.5.3 Trunk
Access

Feature Guide

A user can select the Trunk Access method
every time he makes a trunk call.

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.5.2

Line Preference—Outgoing

Description
A PT user can select the outgoing line he prefers to originate calls on, from the following line
preferences, through personal programming (Preferred Line Assignment—Outgoing):
Feature

Description

Intercom

When an extension user goes off-hook, an extension line is selected
automatically.

Idle Line

When an extension user goes off-hook, an idle trunk is selected
automatically from the assigned trunk groups.

No Line

When an extension user goes off-hook, no line is selected. He must
select the desired line to make a call.

Prime Line

When an extension user goes off-hook, the preset line is selected
automatically. A prime line can be selected from the Line Access
buttons: S-CO, G-CO, L-CO, ICD Group.

Conditions
•

•

Line Preference Override
A user can override the preset Line Preference temporarily by pressing the desired Line
Access button or Memory Dialling button (e.g., One-touch Dialling) before going off-hook.
To select Idle Line Preference, the trunk groups available to the extension should be
programmed on a COS basis ( Trunk Group Number [500]). Also trunk groups available
for Idle Line Access should be assigned ( Idle Line Access (Local Access) [103]).

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

Feature Guide

83

1.5 Making Call Features

1.5.5.3

Trunk Access

Description
There are the following features to access a trunk.
Feature

Description

Accessing method

Idle Line
Access (Local
Access)

Selects an idle trunk
Dial the Idle Line Access number. Or
automatically from the assigned press a L-CO button.
trunk groups.

Trunk Group
Access

Selects an idle trunk from the
corresponding trunk group.

S-CO Line
Access

Selects the desired trunk directly. Dial the S-CO Line Access number and
the trunk number. Or press the S-CO
button.

Dial the Trunk Group Access number
and a trunk group number. Or press a
G-CO button.

Conditions
•
•
•

COS programming determines the trunk groups available for making calls ( Trunk Group
Number [500]).
Trunk numbers can be referred on a trunk port basis ( LCOT/BRI Trunk Number
Reference [409]).
Button Assignment
A flexible button can be customised as a G-CO, L-CO, or S-CO button as follows:
Type

Assignable parameter

Loop-CO (L-CO)

No parameter (All assigned trunk groups
through system programming are applied.)

Group-CO (G-CO)

A trunk group is assigned.

Single-CO (S-CO)

A specified trunk is assigned.

It is possible to assign trunks in the following ways:
– The same trunk to the S-CO button and to a G-CO button
– The same trunk group to more than one G-CO button
– More than one L-CO button

•

•

84

Feature Guide

Dialling the Trunk Access number selects a CO button according to the priority: S-CO
G-CO
L-CO
Direct Trunk Access
By pressing an idle CO button, it automatically switches on the hands-free operation mode
and allows a user to use On-hook Dialling. The user need not press the SP-PHONE
button, MONITOR button, or lift the handset.
Group Hunting Order for Idle Line Access
An idle trunk is selected from the trunk groups assigned for Idle Line Access. If multiple
trunk groups are available, the trunk group hunting sequence can be determined through
system programming.

1.5 Making Call Features

•

•

•

Trunk Hunting Order for Idle Line Access and Trunk Group Access
The trunk hunting sequence in a trunk group; from lowest numbered trunk, from highest
numbered trunk or rotation, can be determined through system programming.
A company name or customer name can be assigned on a trunk port basis ( LCOT/BRI
Trunk Name [401]) so that the operator or extension user can view the destination which
the caller is trying to reach before answering.
It is possible to identify the trunk port that has a trunk connected to it ( LCOT/BRI Trunk
Connection [400]). This prevents extension users from originating a call to a trunk which
is not connected.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.1 Basic Calling

Feature Guide

85

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

1.6

Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1

Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1.1

Memory Dialling Features—SUMMARY

Description
An extension user can store frequently dialled numbers in the PBX extension data and/or the
PBX system data. A stored number is dialled automatically with a simple operation.
1. Features
Feature
One-touch Dialling

Storing Method
•
•

• 1.6.1.2 Onetouch Dialling

KX-T7710 One-touch System Programming
Dialling (KX-TDA100/ (PC Programming only)
KX-TDA200 only)

• 1.6.1.3 KXT7710 One-touch
Dialling (KXTDA100/KXTDA200 only)

Last Number Redial
(Outgoing Call Log)

• 1.6.1.4 Last
Number Redial

Speed
Dialling

The last dialled telephone number(s) is
automatically stored.

Personal •
•
•
System

Personal Programming
Personal Operation with the Feature
Number
System Programming
(PC Programming only)

• 1.6.1.5 Speed
Dialling—
Personal/System

System Programming

Quick Dialling

System Programming
(PC Programming only)

• 1.6.1.6 Quick
Dialling

Hot Line

•
•

Personal Programming
Personal Operation with the Feature
Number
System Programming
(PC Programming only)

• 1.6.1.7 Hot Line

Incoming call information is automatically
stored.

• 1.17.2 Incoming
Call Log

•
Incoming Call Log

86

Personal Programming
System Programming
(PC Programming only)

Details in

Feature Guide

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

2. Valid Input
Display while
Entering

Input

Description

0–9/ /#

0–9/ /#

Stores the digits,

and #.

PAUSE (Pause)

P

Stores a pause by pressing the PAUSE button.
( 1.5.4.6 Pause Insertion)

FLASH/RECALL
(Hooking)*

F

Stores a flash/recall signal (EFA mode) by
pressing the FLASH/RECALL button at the
beginning of the number. ( 1.10.7 External
Feature Access (EFA))

INTERCOM
(Secret)*

[/]

Conceals all or part of the number by pressing the
INTERCOM button at the beginning and at the
end of the number to be concealed. It is
programmable whether the concealed part will
appear on the SMDR.

TRANSFER
(Transfer)*

T

Stores a transfer command by pressing the
TRANSFER button at the beginning of the
number (used only for a One-touch Dialling). (
1.11.1 Call Transfer)
[Example] Storing "T + 305"= Transferring a call
to extension 305.

*: Available only when in the system/personal programming mode
[Example]
When storing the number "9-123-456-7890" and concealing the telephone number "123456-7890",
Enter 9

Notes
•
•

INTERCOM

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0

INTERCOM .

It is possible to store a Memory Dialling feature number in the beginning of the
Memory Dialling numbers.
It is possible to store several feature numbers in one Memory Dialling location.

Conditions
•

Trunk Access by Memory Dialling
A specific Trunk Access number can be stored with the telephone number in Memory
Dialling. However, if Memory Dialling is done after selecting a trunk, the stored Trunk
Access number is ignored and the telephone number is sent using the selected trunk.

Feature Guide

87

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1.2

One-touch Dialling

Description
A PT user can access a person or feature by one-touch. This is activated by storing the number
(e.g., extension number, telephone number, or feature number) in a One-touch Dialling button.

Conditions
•
•

One-touch Dialling Button
A flexible button can be customised as a One-touch Dialling button.
Full One-touch Dialling
There is no need to go off-hook before pressing the One-touch Dialling button.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.2 Easy Dialling

88

Feature Guide

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1.3

KX-T7710 One-touch Dialling (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200
only)

Description
The Message button and One-touch buttons on all KX-T7710 telephones connected to the
PBX can be customised at once through system programming. The same extension number,
telephone number, or feature number will be assigned to the same buttons on each KX-T7710,
useful for hotel room extensions or similar applications.
[Programming Example]
Button

Desired Number

MESSAGE
One-touch Dial 01

702 (Message Waiting [To Call Back])
100 (Front Desk)

One-touch Dial 02
One-touch Dial 03

7601 (Wake-up Call)
102 (Restaurant)

:

:

The MESSAGE button is programmed by default to call back a caller who left a message
waiting indication, however, the MESSAGE button can be programmed to perform other
features. The eight One-touch buttons have no default setting.

Conditions
•
•
•

The KX-T7710 has two modes, NORMAL mode and PBX mode, selected by a switch on
the telephone. This feature is available only when the KX-T7710 is in the PBX mode.
This feature is available while hearing a dial tone.
Please refer to the Quick Reference Guide of the KX-T7710 for additional information.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.2 Easy Dialling

Feature Guide

89

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1.4

Last Number Redial

Description
Every extension automatically saves the last external telephone number dialled to allow the
same number to be dialled again.
Automatic Redial:
If Last Number Redial is performed in hands-free mode and the called party is busy, redialling
will be automatically retried a preprogrammed number of times ( Automatic Redial Repeat
Times [205]) at preprogrammed intervals ( Automatic Redial Interval [206]). The Redial Call
No-answer Ring Duration time is programmable.
This feature is available only on certain PT models which have the SP-PHONE button.
Outgoing Call Log:
The last five dialled numbers are automatically stored at each extension. A display PT user can
redial easily any of the stored numbers.

Conditions
•
•
•
•

•

The memorised telephone number is replaced by a new one.
If any dialling operation is done or an incoming call is answered during Automatic Redial,
Automatic Redial is cancelled.
Automatic Redial is not available for some countries/areas when using an analogue trunk.
Interrupt Redial
When the called party or the seized trunk is busy, it is possible to press the REDIAL button
continuously until the called party or the trunk becomes idle. There is no need to go offhook, before pressing the REDIAL button.
Outgoing Call Log Display by REDIAL Button
Pressing the REDIAL button on a display DPT while on-hook can display the Outgoing Call
Log. System programming is required for this operation.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.3 Redial
1.11.1 Using the Call Log

90

Feature Guide

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1.5

Speed Dialling—Personal/System

Description
An extension user can make calls using abbreviated dialling for frequently dialled numbers
which are stored in the PBX extension data, or the PBX system data ( System Speed Dialling
Number [001]).
Personal Speed Dialling is also known as Station Speed Dialling.

Conditions
[General]
•

•

Any number (e.g., telephone number, feature number) can be stored in a speed dialling
number. A name can be assigned to each Personal Speed Dialling number through
personal programming, and System Speed Dialling number ( System Speed Dialling
Name [002]).
Call Directory—Speed Dialling
Display PT users can make a call by selecting stored names on the display.

[Personal Speed Dialling]
•

Personal Speed Dialling Display Lock
An extension user can lock the Personal Speed Dialling number display to prevent other
users from viewing the number. In this case, the Incoming and Outgoing Call Log
information displays are also locked. An extension personal identification number (PIN) is
required to use this feature. ( 1.26.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN))

[System Speed Dialling]
•

•

TRS/Barring Override by System Speed Dialling
It is possible to override the TRS/Barring using the System Speed Dialling ( TRS/
Barring Level for System Speed Dialling [509]). ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call
Barring (Barring))
System Speed Dialling Display by AUTO DIAL/STORE Button
Pressing the AUTO DIAL/STORE button on a display DPT while on-hook can display the
System Speed Dialling Directory.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.2 Easy Dialling
1.11.1 Using the Call Log
1.11.2 Using the Directories
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode
3.3 Customising Your System (System Programming)

Feature Guide

91

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1.6

Quick Dialling

Description
An extension user can access a person or feature easily. This is enabled by storing the number
(e.g., extension number, telephone number or feature number) for Quick Dialling.

Conditions
•

Quick Dialling is convenient in the following cases:
– Room service calls in a hotel
– Calling another branch via the public network. The extension user needs to dial
only the extension number of another branch.

•
•

Quick Dialling numbers follow the flexible numbering plan.
( 2.3.5 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering)
The storing example is as follows:
Location No.

110

9110 (Trunk Call)

Quick Dialling 02

5

3016 (Room Service)

Quick Dialling 03

2011

90123456789 (Another Branch)

:

:

:

User Manual
1.2.2 Easy Dialling

Feature Guide

Desired Number

Quick Dialling 01

User Manual References

92

Quick Dialling No.

1.6 Memory Dialling Features

1.6.1.7

Hot Line

Description
An extension user can make an outgoing call by only going off-hook, if the user has previously
stored the telephone number or the extension number.
If the Hot Line feature is set and the user goes off-hook, a dial tone is generated for a specified
Waiting time assigned through system programming ( Hot Line Waiting Time [204]) and then
dialling starts. During the Waiting time the user can dial another party, overriding the Hot Line
feature.
This feature is also known as Pickup Dialling.

Conditions
•

Capable Telephone
PT, SLT, T1-OPX, and PS

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.2 Easy Dialling

Feature Guide

93

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7

Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7.1

Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-on)

Description
If the line is busy when a call is made, callback ringing will inform the caller when the line
becomes free using this feature. After the extension answers the callback ringing, the dialled
number is automatically redialled.

Conditions
•
•

•
•
•
•

If the callback ringing is not answered within 10 seconds, the callback is cancelled.
If the extension hears a busy tone before dialling the telephone number, only the trunk or
trunk group is reserved. After answering the callback ringing, the extension should dial the
telephone number.
An extension can set only one Automatic Callback Busy. The last setting is effective.
Multiple extension users can set this feature to one trunk simultaneously.
However, a maximum of four extension users can set this feature to one extension.
The priority of the callback is the setting order.
This feature cannot be used for calls to a VPS or an ISDN extension.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer

94

Feature Guide

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7.2

Executive Busy Override

Description
Allows an extension user to interrupt an existing call to establish a three-party conference call.
Executive Busy Override Deny:
It is possible for extension users to prevent their calls from being intercepted by another
extension user.

Conditions
•

•

COS programming determines extension users who can use the Executive Busy Override
( Executive Busy Override [505]) and set the Executive Busy Override Deny mode (
Executive Busy Override Deny [506]).
This feature does not work when the busy extension is in one of the following conditions:

a) Executive Busy Override Deny or Data Line Security (

1.10.5 Data Line Security)

has been set.

b) While being monitored by another extension ( 1.7.3 Call Monitor).
c) While receiving OHCA ( 1.7.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA)) or Whisper
OHCA (

1.7.4.4 Whisper OHCA).

d) During a Conference call ( 1.13.1 Conference Features).
e) During a doorphone call ( 1.16.1 Doorphone Call).
f) While Live Call Screening (LCS) or Two-way Record is activated (

1.23.3 Voice Mail

DPT (Digital) Integration).

g) During Consultation Hold.

•

(Consultation Hold: Allows an extension user to place a call on hold temporarily to
perform Call Transfer, Conference, or Call Splitting.)
This feature is not available for a trunk-to-trunk call via DISA.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer
1.7.7 Preventing Other People from Joining Your Conversation (Executive Busy Override
Deny)

Feature Guide

95

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7.3

Call Monitor

Description
Allows an extension user to listen to the busy extension user’s existing conversation. The user
can hear the conversation, but the user’s voice is not heard. If desired, interrupting the call to
establish a three-party conference call is available.

Conditions
•
•
•

COS programming determines extension users who can use this feature.
This feature is available only when the busy extension is in a conversation with another
extension or outside party.
This feature does not work when the busy extension is in one of the following conditions:

a) Executive Busy Override Deny (
Security (

1.7.2 Executive Busy Override) or Data Line
1.10.5 Data Line Security) has been set.

b) While receiving OHCA (
OHCA (

1.7.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA)) or Whisper
1.7.4.4 Whisper OHCA).

c) During a Conference call ( 1.13.1 Conference Features).
d) During a doorphone call ( 1.16.1 Doorphone Call).
e) While Live Call Screening (LCS) or Two-way Record is activated (

1.23.3 Voice Mail

DPT (Digital) Integration).

f)

•

During Consultation Hold.

(Consultation Hold: Allows an extension user to place a call on hold temporarily to
perform Call Transfer, Conference, or Call Splitting.)
This feature stops when the busy extension user presses the following buttons during a
conversation ( 1.19.1 Fixed Buttons and 1.19.2 Flexible Buttons):
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–

FLASH/RECALL button
HOLD button
TRANSFER button
CONF (Conference) button
DSS button
EFA button
Two-way Record button
Two-way Transfer button
One-touch Two-way Transfer button
Voice Mail (VM) Transfer button

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer

96

Feature Guide

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7.4

Second Call Notification to Busy Extension

1.7.4.1

Second Call Notification to Busy Extension—SUMMARY

Description
When attempting to call a busy extension (ringing or having a conversation), an extension user
can send call waiting indication to the busy extension (Call Waiting). The notification receiving
method depends on the called extension’s personal setting and the telephone type:
Notification
Receiving Method

Description

Details in

Call Waiting Tone

Sends the Call Waiting tone to the busy
extension.

• 1.7.4.2 Call
Waiting Tone

Off-hook Call
Announcement
(OHCA)

Talk with the busy extension using the built-in
• 1.7.4.3 Offspeaker and microphone of the called extension hook Call
while the existing call is made using the handset. Announcement
(OHCA)

Whisper OHCA

Give a message to the busy extension through
the handset.

• 1.7.4.4
Whisper OHCA

Conditions
•
•
•

Each extension user can choose to receive Call Waiting tone, OHCA, Whisper OHCA, or
none of these.
OHCA and Whisper OHCA are enabled or disabled by the COS of the calling extension.
OHCA and Whisper OHCA do not work for some telephone types. In such cases, the Call
Waiting tone will be sent to the called extension.
Calling
Extension’s
OHCA COS
Mode

•

•

Called Extension’s Call Waiting Mode
OFF

ON

Cancel

Call Waiting Tone

OHCA

Whisper OHCA

Disable

Call Waiting
disabled

Call Waiting tone

Call Waiting
tone

Call Waiting tone

Enable

Call Waiting
disabled

Call Waiting tone

OHCA
(or Call Waiting
tone)

Whisper OHCA
(or Call Waiting
tone)

The notification receiving methods (Call Waiting tone, OHCA, and Whisper OHCA) are
available when the called extension is having a conversation with other party. If not, the
calling extension will be kept waiting until the called extension becomes available to
receive the notification. Even while waiting, the calling extension will hear a ringback tone.
If none of these notification receiving methods, Call Waiting tone, OHCA, or Whisper
OHCA is set at the called party, the caller will hear reorder tone.

Feature Guide

97

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

Feature Guide References
1.1.3.3 Call Waiting

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer

98

Feature Guide

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7.4.2

Call Waiting Tone

Description
When an extension user attempts to call a busy extension (ringing or having a conversation),
the Call Waiting tone can be sent to the called extension to let him know another call is waiting.

Conditions
•
•

This feature only works if the called extension has activated Call Waiting. If it is activated,
the calling extension will hear a ringback tone.
Call Waiting tone can be selected (Tone 1 or Tone 2) through personal programming (Call
Waiting Tone Type Selection).

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

Feature Guide

99

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7.4.3

Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA)

Description
An extension user can talk with a busy extension through the built-in speaker and microphone
of the called party’s PT. If the existing call is using a handset, a second conversation is made
using the speakerphone and microphone so that the called extension can talk to both parties.

Conditions
•
•

COS programming determines which extensions can use this feature.
This feature is available when the called extension uses one of the following telephones:
–
–
–
–

•
•

KX-T7625, KX-T7630, KX-T7633, KX-T7636
KX-T7536
KX-T7436
KX-T7235 (except KX-T7235G/FR/SL/NE)

If the KX-T7235G/FR/SL/NE are connected to the PBX, the OHCA feature for the
KX-T7235 should be disabled through system programming.
The OHCA feature cannot be used in the following cases:
(a) COS or called extension's telephone type is not available for this feature.
(b) The called extension (DPT) is connected to a PC (PC Console or PC Phone)
via the USB Module.
(c) The called extension (DPT) is in the Digital XDP connection.

•

•

100

Feature Guide

The Call Waiting tone is sent to the called extension. ( 1.7.4.2 Call Waiting Tone)
While an extension is receiving OHCA, if the extension user places the current trunk call
on hold or transfers the current intercom call or trunk call, OHCA will become disabled and
the calling extension will start to hear a ringback tone.
While an extension is receiving OHCA, if the extension user places the current intercom
call on hold, the called extension can talk to the calling extension through the handset.

1.7 Busy Line/Busy Party Features

1.7.4.4

Whisper OHCA

Description
An extension user can give a message to a busy extension through the handset.

Conditions
•
•

COS programming determines which extensions can use this feature.
This feature is available when the calling and called extension use one of the following
telephones:
– KX-T7600 series
– KX-T7500 series
– KX-T7400 series (except KX-T7451)

•
•
•
•

•

If the Whisper OHCA feature cannot be used due to COS or telephone type, the Call
Waiting tone will be sent to the called extension. ( 1.7.4.2 Call Waiting Tone)
If the called extension does not use a KX-T7600, KX-T7500, or KX-T7400 series
telephone but forces Whisper OHCA, the announcement may be heard by the other party.
It is possible to enable Whisper OHCA on any telephone. However, it may not work
properly. (e.g., The voice may be heard by the other party.)
While an extension is receiving Whisper OHCA, if the extension user places the current
trunk call on hold or transfers the current intercom call or trunk call, the Whisper OHCA
will become disabled and the calling extension will start to hear a ringback tone.
While an extension is receiving Whisper OHCA, if the extension user places the current
intercom call on hold, the called extension can talk to the calling extension through the
handset.

Feature Guide

101

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

1.8

Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring)
Features

1.8.1

Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring)

Description
TRS/Barring can prohibit an extension user from making certain trunk calls by COS
programming. It is applied when the user goes off-hook, a trunk is seized and then a dialled
number is sent to the trunk.
Each COS is programmed to have a TRS/Barring level for each time mode (day/lunch/break/
night).
There are seven levels available. Level 1 is the highest level and the level 7 is the lowest. That
is, level 1 allows all trunk calls and level 7 prohibits all trunk calls. Levels 2 through 6 are used
to restrict calls by combining preprogrammed Denied and Exception Code Tables.

Denied Code Tables
An outgoing trunk call made by an extension with a level between 2 and 6 is first checked
against the applicable Denied Code Tables. If the leading digits of the dialled number (not
including the Trunk Access number) are not found in the table, the call is made. There are five
Denied Code Tables for Levels 2 through 6 respectively.
Complete every table by storing numbers that are to be prohibited. These numbers are defined
as denied codes.

Exception Code Tables
These tables are used to override a programmed denied code. A call denied by the applicable
Denied Code Tables is checked against the applicable Exception Code Tables, and if a match
is found, the call is made.
There are five Exception Code Tables for Levels 2 through 6 respectively.
Complete every table by storing numbers that are exceptions to the denied codes. These
numbers are defined as exception codes.

TRS/Barring Override by System Speed Dialling
If the call is made using System Speed Dialling, the call can override the TRS/Barring. Each
COS is programmed to have a TRS/Barring level for System Speed Dialling ( TRS/Barring
Override by System Speed Dialling [300]).
Once this feature is set, it permits all extension users to make System Speed Dialling calls with
the level for System Speed Dialling. Any extension which sets Extension Lock can also make
a call using System Speed Dialling.

102

Feature Guide

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

TRS/Barring Level
TRS/Barring level is determined by the applicable levels of Denied Code Tables and Exception
Code Tables.
Denied Code Tables*1

Exception Code Tables*2

Level 1

Not Programmable

Not Programmable

Level 2

Table for Level 2

Tables for Levels 2 through 6

Level 3

Tables for Levels 2 and 3

Tables for Levels 3 through 6

Level 4

Tables for Levels 2 through 4

Tables for Levels 4 through 6

Level 5

Tables for Levels 2 through 5

Tables for Levels 5 through 6

Level 6

Tables for Levels 2 through 6

Tables for Level 6

Level 7

Not Programmable

Not Programmable

TRS/Barring Denied Code [301]
TRS/Barring Exception Code [302]

*1:
*2:

Explanation:
Level 1: Allows all calls.
Level 2: Denies codes stored in the Denied Code Table for Level 2 except the codes
stored in Exception Code Tables for Levels 2 through 6.
Level 3: Denies codes stored in the Denied Code Tables for Levels 2 and 3 except the
codes stored in Exception Code Tables for Levels 3 through 6.
•
•
•
Level 7: Allows intercom calls only.
[Programming Example]
Level for Time Mode*1
Day

Lunch

Break

Night

Level for System
Speed Dialling*2

1

1

1

1

6

1

2

2

2

2

6

1

:

:

:

:

:

:

COS No.

*1:
*2:

TRS/Barring Level [501]
TRS/Barring Level for System Speed Dialling [509]

Feature Guide

103

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

[Flowchart]

An extension user makes
a trunk call.

Is the call made by System
Speed Dialling ?

Yes

No
No

Is TRS/Barring Override by
System Speed Dialling enabled?
Yes

Checks the
TRS/Barring level for
the time mode of the
extension's COS.

Level 7

What is the TRS/Barring level?

Checks the TRS/Barring
level for System Speed
Dialling of the
extension's COS.

Level 1

Levels 2, 3, 4, 5, 6

Is the dialled number found in
applicable Denied Code Tables?

No

Yes

Is the dialled number found in
applicable Exception Code Tables?

Yes

No
The call is denied.
The user hears reorder tone.

104

Feature Guide

The call is made.

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

Conditions
WARNING
The software contained in the TRS/Barring feature to allow user access to the network
must be upgraded to recognise newly established network area codes and exchange
codes as they are placed into service.
Failure to upgrade the premises PBXs or peripheral equipment to recognise the new
codes as they are established will restrict the customer and the customer’s employees
from gaining access to the network and to these codes.
KEEP THE SOFTWARE UP-TO-DATE WITH THE LATEST DATA.
•
•

A COS should be assigned for each extension. (
TRS/Barring checks are applied to the following:

Class of Service [602])

– ARS
– Trunk Access (Idle Line/Trunk Group/S-CO Line)
•

•
•

It is programmable whether " " or "#" is checked by the TRS/Barring. This is useful in
preventing unauthorised calls which could be possible through certain telephone company
exchanges.
It is programmable whether TRS/Barring checks the digits dialled after the External
Feature Access during a trunk call. ( 1.10.7 External Feature Access (EFA))
Host PBX Access Code/Special Carrier Access Code
TRS/Barring checks for numbers dialled with a Host PBX Access code ( 1.5.4.7 Host
PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX)) or a
Special Carrier Access code ( 1.5.4.8 Special Carrier Access Code) in the following
cases:
Stored
Type

Not stored
Found

Host PBX
Access Code

Deletes the code. A
TRS/Barring check is
carried out on the
following digits.

Special Carrier Deletes the code. A
Access Code TRS/Barring check is
carried out on the
following digits.
•

•

•

Not found
The call is made
(excepted from TRS/
Barring).

TRS/Barring checks
the whole number.

TRS/Barring checks
the whole number.

TRS/Barring checks
the whole number.

ARS
If ARS is applied to a dialled number, TRS/Barring will check the user-dialled number (not
the modified number by ARS). In this case, a Host PBX Access code and/or a Special
Carrier Access code will not be checked.
Dialling Digit Restriction during Conversation
The dialling of digits can be restricted while engaged on a received trunk call. If the number
of dialled digits exceeds the preprogrammed limitation, the line will be disconnected.
A TRS/Barring level can be changed by some features. The priority of features, when
multiple features are used, is as follows:
1) Dial Tone Transfer ( 1.8.4 Dial Tone Transfer)
2) Budget Management ( 1.8.2 Budget Management)
3) TRS/Barring Override by System Speed Dialling

Feature Guide

105

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

4) Walking COS/Verified Code Entry
( 1.8.5 Walking COS, 1.8.6 Verified Code Entry)
5) Extension Lock

Feature Guide References
1.5.5.3 Trunk Access
1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System
1.8.3 Extension Lock
1.9.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
2.2.4 Time Service

106

Feature Guide

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

1.8.2

Budget Management

Description
Limits the telephone usage to a preprogrammed budget on an extension basis. If the amount
of the call charge reaches the limit, an extension user cannot make further trunk calls. An
extension assigned as the manager may increase the limit or clear the amount of the call
charge.

Conditions
•
•

•
•

If the limit is reached, TRS/Barring Level 7 is applied. ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call
Barring (Barring))
Budget Management for Verified Call
If an extension user make a trunk call with a verified code, the call charge will be counted
on the verified code (not the extension). ( 1.8.6 Verified Code Entry) The limit of the call
charge can be assigned on each verified code.
The pay tone service or ISDN Advice of Charge (AOC) service is required for this feature.
It is possible to select whether to disconnect the line after an alarm tone or only to send
an alarm tone when the amount of the call charge reaches the preprogrammed limit during
a conversation.

User Manual References
User Manual
3.2.2 Manager Programming

Feature Guide

107

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

1.8.3

Extension Lock

Description
An extension user can change the TRS/Barring level of the telephone ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction
(TRS)/Call Barring (Barring)) so that other users cannot make inappropriate trunk calls. An
extension personal identification number (PIN) is used to unlock the telephone ( 1.26.1
Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN)).
This feature is also known as Electronic Station Lockout.

Conditions
•
•

•

This feature also restricts changing the FWD destination. ( 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding
(FWD))
Remote Extension Lock
Overrides Extension Lock. If an extension assigned as the manager sets Remote
Extension Lock on an extension that has already been locked by the extension user, the
user cannot unlock it. If a manager extension unlocks an extension that has been locked
by the extension user, the extension will be unlocked.
This feature is also known as Remote Station Lock Control.
TRS/Barring Level
COS programming determines the TRS/Barring level for Extension Lock ( TRS/Barring
Level for Extension Lock [510]).

User Manual References
User Manual
1.5.3 Preventing Other People from Using Your Telephone (Extension Lock)
2.1.1 Extension Control

108

Feature Guide

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

1.8.4

Dial Tone Transfer

Description
An extension assigned as the manager can change the TRS/Barring level ( 1.8.1 Toll
Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring)) for the extension user temporarily. After that, the
extension user can make his call.
[Example] An extension user can call a manager to release the restriction on outgoing call
(e.g., international calls).

(3) Make a trunk call
(2) Change
TRS/Barring level
Toll Restriction/
Call Barring button

(1) Call
Guest Room
(Trunk call
restricted)

Manager

Conditions
•
•

The changed level effects just one time.
Toll Restriction/Call Barring Button
A manager extension must store the desired TRS/Barring level in the Toll Restriction/Call
Barring button. A flexible button can be customised as the Toll Restriction/Call Barring
button.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
2.1.3 Restriction Level Control (Dial Tone Transfer)

Feature Guide

109

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

1.8.5

Walking COS

Description
An extension user can use another extension telephone with the COS assigned on his own
extension temporarily. The extension accesses his own extension from another telephone and
operates features with the same conditions which are assigned his own extension. It is one of
the remote operations. An extension personal identification number (PIN) is required to use this
feature ( 1.26.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN)).

Conditions
•

The following items are applied:
–
–
–
–

•

COS programming
Budget Management ( 1.8.2 Budget Management)
Itemised Billing code for ARS ( 1.9.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS))
Extension number recorded on the SMDR ( 1.25.1 Station Message Detail
Recording (SMDR)).

Walking COS through DISA
This feature is also available through the DISA. (
(DISA))

Feature Guide References
2.2.1 Class of Service (COS)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.7 Calling without Restrictions

110

Feature Guide

1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

1.8.6

Verified Code Entry

Description
An extension user can make a trunk call with a verified code from his own or any other
extension to change the TRS/Barring level ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring
(Barring)) or to identify the call for accounting and billing purposes. A verified code personal
identification number (PIN) is required to use this feature.

Conditions
WARNING
When a third party discovers the personal identification number (PIN) (verified code PIN/
extension PIN) of the PBX, there will be a risk that they will make fraudulent phone calls
using the telephone line, and the cost will be charged to your own account. In order to
avoid this problem, we strongly recommend the following points:

a) Carefully maintain the secrecy of the PIN.
b) Specify a complicated PIN as long and random as you can make it.
c) Change the PIN frequently.
•

The following items are applied:
–
–
–
–

•

•

•

COS programming
Budget Management
Itemised Billing code for ARS
The + verified code recorded on the SMDR instead of the extension number
( 1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)).

Verified Code Entry through DISA
This feature is also available through the DISA. ( 1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access
(DISA))
Verified Code PIN
A verified code PIN must be assigned for each verified code through system programming
( Verified Code Personal Identification Number (PIN) [122]) or through manager
programming.
Verified Code PIN Lock
If the wrong PIN is entered incorrectly three times, the line will be disconnected. If the
incorrect PIN is entered a preprogrammed number of times successively, the PIN against
the verified code will be locked. Only an extension assigned as the manager can unlock it.
In this case, the PIN will be unlocked and cleared.

Feature Guide

111

1.8 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring) Features

•

Budget Management for Verified Calls
A limit of the call charge can be assigned on each verified code.
[Example of Verified Codes and Their Programming]
Location Verified
No.
Code*1

*1 :
*2 :
*3 :

Verified
Code PIN

COS
No.*3

1234

1

2323

5000Yen

3

4545

3000Yen

:

:

:

0001

1111

Tom Smith

0002

2222

John White 9876543210

:

:

:

1.8.2 Budget Management
1.9.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
2.2.1 Class of Service (COS)
2.2.6 Manager Features

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.7 Calling without Restrictions
3.2.2 Manager Programming

Feature Guide

:

Verified Code [120]
Verified Code Name [121]
Verified Code COS Number [123]

Feature Guide References

112

Itemised
Budget
Billing Code
Management
for ARS

User
Name*2

1.9 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features

1.9

Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features

1.9.1

Automatic Route Selection (ARS)

Description
ARS automatically selects the carrier available at the time an outgoing trunk call is made
according to preprogrammed settings. The dialled number will be checked and modified to
connect the appropriate carrier.
[Carrier Selection Procedure Flowchart]
The numbers
pages.

X

in the flowchart correspond to the [Programming Procedures] on the following

A trunk call is made.

Is the ARS mode ( 1 ) enabled?

No (Normal Trunk Access)
Sends the telephone
number to the userselected carrier.

Yes
Is the dialled number found in the
Leading Number Exception Table ( 2 )?

Yes

No
Is the dialled number found in the
Leading Number Table ( 3 )?

No

Yes
Checks the Routing Plan Table ( 4 )
to determine which carrier to use.

Is the carrier ( 6 ) found in the
appropriate time block ( 5 )?

No

Yes
Is there an available
trunk group ( 11 )?
Yes
Modifies the dialled number by
removing the digits ( 9 ) and
following the modify commands ( 12 ).

No
Because all
trunks are busy?
Yes

No

Is normal
Trunk Access
allowed?

Yes
(default)

No
Sends the modified number
to the trunk.

Sends a
busy tone.

Sends a
reorder tone.

Sends the
telephone number
by the Idle Line
Access.

Feature Guide

113

1.9 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features

[Programming Procedures]
1. ARS Mode

Assignment ( ARS Mode [320])
It is possible to select whether ARS operates when an extension user makes a call using
any Idle Line Access method or when an extension user makes a call using any Trunk
Access method. ( 1.5.5.3 Trunk Access)
1

2. Leading Number Exception Table

Assignment
Store the telephone numbers that will avoid using the ARS feature.
2

2 ARS Leading Number Exception Table

Location
Leading No.
No.
Exception*1
033555
001
06456
002
:
:
*1 :

ARS Exception Number [325]

3. Leading Number Table

3 Assignment
Store the area codes and/or telephone numbers as leading number that will be routed by
the ARS feature. In this table, the Routing Plan (refer to "4. Routing Plan Table 4
Assignment") is selected for each number.
The additional (remain) number of digits must be assigned only when "#", for example, is
needed after a dialled number. The "#" is added after the assigned number of digits of
dialled number (excluding a leading number).

3 ARS Leading Number Table

Location Leading Additional (Remain) Routing Plan
No.
No. of Digits
Table No.*2
No.*1
0001
1
7
039
0002
4
0
03
0003
5
0444
5
:
:
:
:
*1 :
*2 :

ARS Leading Number [321]
ARS Routing Plan Table Number [322]

If a dialled number matches a leading number, the number will be modified according to
the corresponding Routing Plan Table and the modified number will be sent to the trunk
when the assigned additional (remain) number of digits are dialled.
If a dialled number matches multiple leading number entries, the leading number entry
with the lowest numbered location will have priority.

114

Feature Guide

1.9 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features

[Example]
Dialled
Number

Corresponding
Routing Plan Table No.

039-123-4567

1

"039" is found in location 0001 and seven
digits (assigned additional [remain] number
of digits in location 0001) were dialled. The
Routing Plan Table 1 is selected just after
the seventh digit.

039-654-321

1

"039" is found in location 0001 and the
Inter-digit time expired before the seventh
digit is received. The Routing Plan Table 1
is selected after the Inter-digit time expired.

038

4

"03" is found in two locations (locations
0001 and 0002), so the PBX waits for the
next digit "8". "038" is not found in any
location, then "03" (location 0002) is
selected. The Routing Plan Table 4 is
selected.

4. Routing Plan Table

Description

Assignment
Arrange the time schedule as desired and store the carrier priority.
4

Time Table 5
As the best carrier may vary with the day of the week and the time of day, four time blocks
(Time-A through D) can be programmed for each day of the week.
Carrier Priority 6
Assign the appropriate carrier (refer to "5. Carrier Table 7 Assignment") and their priority
in each time block. The carrier is selected in the entry order (the order in which entries are
listed).
3 ARS Leading Number Table
Location Leading Additional Routing Plan
(Remain)
No.
No. No. of Digits Table No.
1
03
8
0001
:
:
:
:

4 ARS Routing Plan Table
Routing Plan Table 1
5 Time Table*1

SUN Time-A
Time-B
Time-C
Time-D
:
:
SAT Time-A
Time-B
Time-C
Time-D
*1:
*2:

9:00
12:00
15:00
21:00
:
9:00
12:00
15:00
21:00

6 Carrier*2
Priority 1 Priority 2
1 (A telecom) 4 (D telecom)
1 (A telecom) 2 (B telecom)
1 (A telecom) 2 (B telecom)
3 (C telecom) 1 (A telecom)
:
:
3 (C telecom) 2 (B telecom)
3 (C telecom) 1 (A telecom)
3 (C telecom) 1 (A telecom)
3 (C telecom) 2 (B telecom)

...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...

ARS Routing Plan Time Table [330]
ARS Routing Plan Table (1–16) [331–346]

Feature Guide

115

1.9 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features

5. Carrier Table

7

Carrier Name

8

Assignment
A specified number of carriers can be programmed. Assign the following items for each
Carrier Table:
: Assign the carrier name.

Removed Number of Digits
of the user-dialled number.
Carrier Access Code
Trunk Group

11 :

10 :

9:

Assign the number of digits to remove from the beginning

Assign the code to access the carrier.

Assign the trunk groups which connect to each carrier.

Modify Command 12 : Assign the commands to modify the dialled number to access the
carrier.
[Command Explanation]
Command
Number

Description
Add the number.

C

Add the Carrier Access code.

P

Analogue Line: Insert a pause.
ISDN/T1/E1 Line: Insert a pause and change to tone (DTMF) signal.

A

Add the Authorisation code for a tenant ( 13 ).

G

Add the Authorisation code for a trunk group ( 14 ).

I

Add the Itemised Billing code ( 15 ).

H

Add the dialled number after the digits are removed (Home position).

[Programming Example]
7 Carrier Table
8 Carrier Name*1
9 Removed Number of Digits*2

Carrier Access Code*3
11 Trunk Group*4
12 Modify Command
10

1
A telecom
6
0077
1, 2, 3
CH#12

2
B telecom
0
0088
1, 2
CH

[Example]
Dialled number: 0123456789
(Trunk Access no. is ignored.)
Modification:
12

012345 6789

0077 6789 #12
H

9 Remove 6 digits.

#12 Add the number.
C Add the Carrier Access

code ( 10 ).

*1 :
*2 :

116

Feature Guide

ARS Carrier Name [350]
ARS Removed Number of Digits for Carrier Access [352]

1.9 Automatic Route Selection (ARS) Features

ARS Carrier Access Code [353]
ARS Trunk Group for Carrier Access [351]

*3:
*4:

6. Optional Assignment
Authorisation Code for a Tenant 13
An Authorisation code can be assigned for each carrier and each tenant.
Authorisation Code for a Trunk Group 14
An Authorisation code can be assigned for each trunk group and each carrier.
Itemised Billing Code 15
An Itemised Billing code can be assigned for each extension and for each verified code.
If a call is not made from an extension (e.g., DISA or TIE) and no verified code is used, the
Itemised Billing code assigned in the location 1 of the verified code will be used.

Conditions
WARNING
The software contained in the ARS feature to allow user access to the network must be
upgraded to recognise newly established network area codes and exchange codes as
they are placed into service.
Failure to upgrade the premises PBXs or peripheral equipment to recognise the new
codes as they are established will restrict the customer and the customer’s employees
from gaining access to the network and to these codes.
KEEP THE SOFTWARE UP-TO-DATE WITH THE LATEST DATA.
•

•

The Dialled Number on the SMDR
It is possible to choose to print either the user-dialled number or the modified number on
the SMDR through system programming. ( 1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording
(SMDR))
ARS Data Download/Upload
It is possible to download or upload the following ARS data to the PBX using PC
programming:
–
–
–

•

2
3
4

ARS Leading Number Exception Table
ARS Leading Number Table
ARS Routing Plan Table

This is useful when a carrier has changed the call charge, and the updated data can be
used for multiple customers.
A TRS/Barring check is done before ARS is applied. ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call
Barring (Barring))

Feature Guide

117

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10 Conversation Features
1.10.1 Hands-free Operation
Description
A PT user can talk to another party without lifting the handset. Pressing specific buttons (e.g.,
REDIAL) automatically activate hands-free mode.

Conditions
•

118

Feature Guide

PTs with the MONITOR Button
PTs with the MONITOR button can only dial in hands-free mode and cannot be used for
hands-free conversations.

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.2 Off-hook Monitor
Description
A PT user can let others listen to the user’s conversation through the built-in speaker, during a
conversation using the handset.

Conditions
•

Capable Telephone
KX-T7400 series and KX-T7500 series (display PT only), and all KX-T7600 series
telephones
To enable this feature, system programming is required. If disabled, hands-free
conversation is performed instead.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.7 Letting Other People Listen to the Conversation (Off-hook Monitor)

Feature Guide

119

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.3 Mute
Description
During a conversation, a PT user can disable the speaker microphone or the handset
microphone to consult privately with others while listening to the other party on the phone
through the built-in speaker or the handset receiver. The user can hear the other party’s voice
during Mute. Only your voice will be muted.

Conditions
•

This feature is available with all PTs that have the AUTO ANS/MUTE button.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.6 Mute

120

Feature Guide

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.4 Headset Operation
Description
This PBX provides headset compatible PTs. A PT user can talk to another party without lifting
the handset.
For connection and operation, refer to the Operating Instructions for the headset.
This feature is also known as Handset/Headset Selection.

Conditions
•
•
•

•

•

•
•

A headset is an option.
If the headset mode is on, pressing the SP-PHONE button activates the headset, not the
built-in speaker.
To set the headset mode on a DPT, use personal programming (Headset Operation) or
press the Headset button. To set headset mode on an APT, use the handset/headset
selector provided on the set and/or on the headset.
Headset Button
A flexible button on a DPT can be customised as the Headset button. The Headset button
can be also assigned to a flexible button on an APT, but the button does not work.
Answer/Release Button
A flexible button can be customised as an Answer button or a Release button. Such
buttons are useful for headset operation. It is possible to answer an incoming call by
pressing an Answer button. While hearing the Call Waiting tone during a conversation,
pressing an Answer button enables one to answer the second call by placing the current
call on hold. Pressing a Release button enables one to disconnect the line during or after
conversation, or to complete a Call Transfer.
It is possible to switch the headset mode to the hands-free mode or vice versa during a
conversation by pressing the Headset button.
Headset users cannot use the following features:
– Automatic Redial ( 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial)
– Receiving OHCA ( 1.7.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA))
– Receiving Whisper OHCA ( 1.7.4.4 Whisper OHCA)

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.3.5 Using the ANSWER/RELEASE Button
1.4.8 Using the Headset (Headset Operation)
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

Feature Guide

121

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.5 Data Line Security
Description
Once Data Line Security is set on an extension, communication between the extension and the
other party is protected from signals such as Call Waiting, Hold Recall and Executive Busy
Override. Extension which has data devices connected (e.g., fax machine) may set this feature
to maintain secure data transmission against tones or interruptions from other extensions
during communication.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.9 Protecting Your Line against Notification Tones (Data Line Security)

122

Feature Guide

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.6 Flash/Recall/Terminate
Description
The FLASH/RECALL button (Flash/Recall mode or Terminate mode) or Terminate button
(Terminate mode) is used when a PT user disconnects the current call and originates another
call without hanging up first. It performs as going on-hook and then going off-hook.
[Explanation of Each Mode]
Flash/Recall Mode: Disconnects the line and the extension user hears the dial tone from the
line used last. For example, if a trunk call is disconnected, the extension user will hear a new
dial tone from the telephone company.
Terminate Mode: Disconnects the line and the extension user hears the dial tone determined
by the Line Preference—Outgoing setting. ( 1.5.5.2 Line Preference—Outgoing)

Conditions
•

FLASH/RECALL Button Mode
One of the following modes can be selected for each extension through system
programming:
– Flash/Recall mode
– Terminate mode
– External Feature Access (EFA) mode. (

•
•

•

•

1.10.7 External Feature Access (EFA))

Terminate Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Terminate button.
Disconnect Time (Only for Flash/Recall Mode)
The amount of time between successive accesses to the same trunk is programmable for
each trunk port ( LCOT Disconnect Time [418]).
This feature outputs an SMDR call record ( 1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording
(SMDR)), restarts the call timer, inserts the automatic pause, and checks the TRS/Barring
level ( 1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring)) again.
If the ARS mode is on ( 1.9.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS)) or if a trunk call is
established through the INTERCOM button or ICD Group button, the Terminate mode will
be always effective even though the Flash/Recall mode has been set.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

Feature Guide

123

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.7 External Feature Access (EFA)
Description
An extension user can have access to the features of a host PBX or the telephone company,
such as Transfer, Hold, Call Waiting, etc. A flash/recall signal is sent to the host PBX or the
telephone company. This is only available on trunk calls (including Host PBX Access [
1.5.4.7 Host PBX Access Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a Host PBX)]).

Conditions
•

•
•

Flash/Recall Time
The Flash/Recall time can be assigned for each trunk port ( LCOT Flash/Recall Time
[417]).
EFA Button
A flexible button can be customised as the EFA button.
Pressing the FLASH/RECALL button which is set to EFA mode ( 1.10.6 Flash/Recall/
Terminate) or the EFA button performs this feature. It is also possible to perform this
feature by entering the feature number when the current call is placed on a Consultation
Hold.
(Consultation Hold: Allows an extension user to place a call on hold temporarily to
perform Call Transfer, Conference, or Call Splitting.)

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.9.2 If a Host PBX is Connected

124

Feature Guide

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.8 Trunk Call Limitation
Description
Trunk calls are limited by the following features:
Feature

Description

Extension-to-Trunk Call
Duration

If a call between an extension user and an outside party is
established, the call duration can be restricted by a system timer
selected for each trunk group ( Extension-to-Trunk Call
Duration [472]). Both parties will hear an alarm tone 15 seconds
before the time-limit at five second intervals. If the timer expires,
the line will be disconnected.
COS programming determines to enable or disable this feature
( Trunk Call Duration Limitation [502]). Whether this feature is
applied to outgoing calls only or all calls is also programmable.

Trunk-to-Trunk Call
(except Unattended
Conference Call)
Duration

If a call between two outside parties is established, the call
duration can be restricted by a system timer selected for each
trunk group ( Trunk-to-Trunk Call Duration [473]). Both parties
will hear an alarm tone 15 seconds before the time-limit at five
second intervals. If the timer expires, the line will be
disconnected.
The timer is applied for a trunk call which is made via the PBX.
If both call is made by the extension (e.g., a trunk call made by
an extension is transferred to an outside party), the shorter limit
will apply to the call.

Budget Management

When the preprogrammed call charge limit is reached, an
extension user will start to hear an alarm tone three times at five
second intervals and the user cannot make further trunk calls.
Whether the line is disconnected after the alarm tone is
programmable. ( 1.8.2 Budget Management)

Dialling Digit Restriction While engaged on a received trunk call, the dialling of digits can
during Conversation
be restricted. If the number of dialled digits exceeds the
limitation, the line will be disconnected.

Conditions
•

During an Unattended Conference Call, the Unattended Conference Recall time is
applied. ( 1.13.1.2 Conference)

Feature Guide

125

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.9 Parallelled Telephone
Description
Multiple telephones can be connected to the same port. This is useful to increase the number
of telephones without additional extension cards. The combinations and features of the
parallelled telephones are described below.
Features
Parallel
Mode

Descriptions

Connections

Parallel connection allows the connection of an
SLT to an APT or a DPT that is connected to a
Super Hybrid port.
When parallel mode is enabled, the two
telephones function as follows:
•
Both share one extension number
(main telephone’s extension number).
•
Either telephone can make or answer
a call.
•
If one goes off-hook while the other is
on a call, the call is switched to the
former.

APT/DPT + SLT

EXtra Device XDP mode can be used when the main
Port (XDP)
telephone in a parallel connection is a DPT
connected to a Super Hybrid port.
Mode
Unlike parallel mode, each telephone can act
as a completely different extension with its own
extension number. ( 2.1.1 Extension Port
Configuration)

The Digital XDP allows two DPTs to be
connected together when one of them is
connected to the following port:
•
a DPT or Super Hybrid port (with the
KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200)
•
a Super Hybrid port (with the KXTDA15)
The DPT that is connected directly to the PBX
is called the "master DPT", and the DPT
Deleted: the connected to the master is the "slave DPT".
Like XDP mode, each telephone can act as a
completely different extension with its own
extension number.
In addition to a slave DPT, the master DPT
(connected to a Super Hybrid port) can have an
SLT in parallel or XDP mode.

PBX
DPT

Extn. 101 Extn. 101

APT

Feature Guide

SLT

Extn. 102 Extn. 102

DPT + SLT

PBX
DPT

SLT

Extn. 101 Extn. 105

Digital XDP

126

SLT

DPT + DPT

PBX
Master

Slave

DPT

DPT

Extn. 101 Extn. 201

DPT + DPT + SLT

PBX

Master

Slave

DPT

DPT

Extn. 101 Extn. 201

SLT
Extn. 101 (in Parallel Mode)
or
Extn. 105 (in XDP Mode)

1.10 Conversation Features

Features

Descriptions

Wireless
For this connection, refer to the Wireless XDP
XDP Parallel Parallel mode feature. ( 1.24.5 Wireless XDP
Mode
Parallel Mode)

Connections
APT/DPT/SLT + PS

PBX

PT
Extn. 101

PS
Extn. 101

SLT
Extn. 102

PS
Extn. 102

Conditions
[APT + SLT]
•
•

If one telephone goes off-hook while the other is on a call, a three-party call is established.
If one user goes on-hook, the other user continues the call.
An extension user cannot originate a call from the SLT if the APT is:
– playing background music (BGM)
– receiving a paging announcement over the built-in speaker.

•

The SLT will always ring for incoming calls (if its ringer is turned on). It cannot be
programmed to not ring.

[DPT + SLT]
•
•

•

When in the parallel mode, the XDP mode of the Super Hybrid port should be off through
system programming.
Whether the SLT rings for incoming calls is programmable.
Ring on: Both telephones ring except when the PT is in Hands-free Answerback mode
( 1.4.1.4 Hands-free Answerback) or voice-calling mode (Alternate Receiving Ring/
Voice) ( 1.5.3 Intercom Call).
Ring off: Only the PT rings. However, the SLT can answer the call.
If one goes off-hook while the other is on a call, the call is switched to the former. However,
the call will not be switched in one of the following conditions:

a) While being monitored by another extension. ( 1.5.3 Intercom Call)
b) While receiving OHCA ( 1.7.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA)) or Whisper
OHCA. (

1.7.4.4 Whisper OHCA)

c) During a Conference call ( 1.13.1 Conference Features).
d) While Live Call Screening (LCS) or Two-way Record is activated (

1.23.3 Voice Mail

DPT (Digital) Integration).

Feature Guide

127

1.10 Conversation Features

[DPT + DPT]
•
•

•

•

Available Telephones
KX-T7600 series (except KX-T7640)
KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only
Digital XDP connection enables the maximum number of DPTs that the PBX supports to
be increased. This increase is only available when (1) the MEC card is installed and (2) a
high-capacity power supply unit (with the KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200) is installed or an
additional AC adaptor (with the KX-TDA30) is connected.
KX-TDA15 only
Digital XDP connection is available only for a DPT that is connected to a Super Hybrid
port.
When using Digital XDP connection, the following features cannot be used with the DPTs:

a) OHCA: A call waiting tone will be heard even if the OHCA feature is set.
b) USB Module: The DPTs will not work correctly if a USB Module is connected. Do not
connect USB Modules to the DPTs.
Note
Even if the slave DPT is disconnected, the OHCA feature and USB Module still cannot be
used with the master DPT. To use them, the DPT must be disconnected from the PBX, and
then reconnected.

[DPT + DPT + SLT]
•

When an SLT is connected to the slave DPT in parallel mode, the SLT works as the parallel
extension of the master DPT.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.3.2 MEC Card
2.7.2 Parallel Connection of the Extensions
2.7.3 Digital EXtra Device Port (Digital XDP) Connection

6.5.6 MEC Card
6.6.2 Parallel Connection of the Extensions
6.6.3 Digital EXtra Device Port (Digital XDP) Connection

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.11 Setting the Parallelled Telephone to Ring (Parallelled Telephone)

128

Feature Guide

1.10 Conversation Features

1.10.10 Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection
Description
The Calling Party Control (CPC) signal is an on-hook indication (disconnect signal) sent from
the analogue trunk when the other party is hung up. To maintain efficient utilisation of trunks,
the PBX monitors their state and when CPC signal is detected from a line, the PBX disconnects
the line and alerts the extension with reorder tone.

Conditions
•

•
•
•

CPC signal detection is programmable for incoming trunk calls ( LCOT CPC Signal
Detection Time—Incoming [414]), and for outgoing trunk calls ( LCOT CPC Signal
Detection Time—Outgoing [413]).
If your telephone company sends signals similar to CPC, it is recommended not to enable
CPC signal detection on outgoing trunk calls.
If CPC signal is detected during a Conference call ( 1.13.1.2 Conference), the line is
disconnected. The remaining parties stay connected.
If CPC signal is detected during a call between a caller using the DISA feature ( 1.16.6
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)) and an extension or an outside party, the line is
disconnected.

Feature Guide

129

1.11 Transferring Features

1.11 Transferring Features
1.11.1 Call Transfer
Description
An extension user can transfer a call to another extension or an outside party. The following
features are available:
Feature

Transferring method

With
Announcement

Transfer is completed after announcing the destination
party.

Without
Announcement

Transfer is completed without an announcement.
After dialling the destination, while hearing a ringback
tone, the originator can replace the handset.

Call Transfer with Announcement is also known as Call Transfer—Screened.
Call Transfer without Announcement is also known as Call Transfer—Unscreened.

Conditions
•

•
•

•

If Music on Hold is enabled, music can be sent to the held party while the call is
transferred. ( 1.12.4 Music on Hold) It is programmable whether a ringback tone or
music is sent ( Music for Transfer [712]).
If the transfer destination extension has set FWD to an outside party, the call will be
transferred to the outside party. ( 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD))
COS programming determines the extensions that are able to transfer a call to an outside
party ( Call Transfer to Trunk [503]). COS can also prohibit transferring to an extension
of another PBX via the TIE line service using the PBX Code method (Access with PBX
Code) ( 1.28.1 TIE Line Service).
Transfer Recall for Call Transfer without Announcement
If the transfer destination does not answer within the preprogrammed Transfer Recall time
( Transfer Recall Time [201]), the call will be redirected to the Transfer Recall destination
assigned to the extension which transferred the call. If the destination is not assigned, the
call will return to the extension.
[Available destination]
Destination
Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1OPX)
PS
Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
VM Group (DTMF/DPT)
External Pager (TAFAS)

130

Feature Guide

Availability

1.11 Transferring Features

Destination

Availability

DISA
Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance
Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.
Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.
Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)
Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)
•

One-touch Transfer
The DSS Console and the PT user can hold a call and quickly transfer it to an extension
by pressing the DSS button directly. A One-touch Dialling button can also be used if the
TRANSFER command is stored with a number ( 1.6.1 Memory Dialling Features).

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.1 Transferring a Call (Call Transfer)

Feature Guide

131

1.12 Holding Features

1.12 Holding Features
1.12.1 Call Hold
Description
An extension user can put a call on hold. The following features are available depending on the
result.
Feature

Description

Call Hold General

Any extension can retrieve a held call.

Exclusive Call Hold

Only the extension user who held the call can retrieve it.

The result of the holding operation can be determined through system programming. Pressing
the HOLD button again just after the first time alternates the mode between General and
Exclusive Call Hold.

Conditions
•

•
•

•
•

•

•

132

Feature Guide

A PT user can hold an intercom call and multiple trunk calls simultaneously. An SLT user
can hold either an intercom call or a trunk call. To hold multiple intercom calls on a PT
simultaneously, use the Call Park feature ( 1.12.2 Call Park). Call Park feature can also
be used to hold multiple intercom calls and/or trunk calls simultaneously on an SLT.
Music on Hold
Music, if available, is sent to the held party. ( 1.12.4 Music on Hold)
Hold Recall
If a call on hold is not retrieved within a preprogrammed time period ( Hold Recall Time
[200]), Hold Recall is heard at the extension which put the call on hold. If the extension is
engaged in a call, the Hold Alarm will be heard.
If an outside party is placed on hold and not retrieved within a preprogrammed time period,
the call is automatically disconnected. This timer starts when Hold Recall activates.
Automatic Call Hold
A PT user can be programmed holding of the current call when pressing another CO/ICD
Group/INTERCOM button, through system programming. If this feature is not enabled, the
current call will be disconnected.
[Example]
It is possible to receive a call by pressing the flashing ICD Group button, this puts the
current intercom call (on the INTERCOM button) on hold. To return to the held call, press
the INTERCOM button.
Call Hold Retrieve Deny
If an extension user cannot call certain extensions on a COS basis ( 1.1.2.2 Internal Call
Block), he cannot retrieve the held call which the extensions made.
SLT Hold Mode
It is possible to choose how to hold a line and transfer a call with an SLT in the following
methods through system programming:

1.12 Holding Features

Hold
Mode 1

Transfer to Trunk

Transfer to Extension

Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch
+
+
+
Going on-hook
Trunk Access No.
Extension No.

Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch
+
+
+
Mode 2
Hold Feature No.
Trunk Access No.
Extension No.
(Default)
+
Going on-hook

Mode 3

Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch
+
+
+
Hold Feature No.
Hold Feature No.
Extension No.
+
+
Going on-hook
Trunk Access No.

Mode 4

Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch Flashing the hookswitch
+
+
+
Hold Feature No.
Hold Feature No.
Hold Feature No.
+
+
+
Going on-hook
Trunk Access No.
Extension No.

If the following occurs frequently with an SLT, choose "Mode 2", "Mode 3", or "Mode 4":

a) When an SLT user receives a call, reorder tone is heard or nobody answers the
call.

b) When an SLT user goes off-hook, reorder tone is heard instead of a dial tone.

•

If a call is not terminated after going on-hook, the above cases occur. To avoid these
problems, choose "Mode 2", "Mode 3", or "Mode 4". Every call will be terminated unless
the Hold feature number is entered after flashing the hookswitch in Mode 2, Mode 3, and
Mode 4.
Hold Alarm tone pattern has a default. ( 4.2.1 Tones/Ring Tones).

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.2 Holding a Call

Feature Guide

133

1.12 Holding Features

1.12.2 Call Park
Description
An extension user can place a call into a common parking zone of the PBX. The Call Park
feature can be used as a transferring feature; this releases the user from the parked call to
perform other operations. The parked call can be retrieved by any extension user.

Conditions
•
•

•

•
•

Automatic Call Park
It is possible to select an idle parking zone automatically.
Retry
If the specified parking zone is occupied or there is no vacant zone for Automatic Call Park,
the originator will hear a busy tone. Retrying is possible while hearing the busy tone by
selecting parking zone or a vacant zone.
Call Park Recall
If a parked call is not retrieved within a preprogrammed time period, Call Park Recall will
be heard at the Transfer Recall destination assigned to the extension which parked the
call. If the destination is engaged in a call, the Hold Alarm will be heard.
If a parked trunk call is not retrieved within a preprogrammed time period (Default: 30
minutes), it is automatically disconnected.
Call Park Button
Pressing the Call Park button parks or retrieves a call in a preset parking zone.
A flexible button can be customised as the Call Park button. It shows the current status of
the preset parking zone as follows:
Light pattern

•

•

Slow red flashing

Parked in the preset parking zone

Off

No parked call

Call Park (Automatic Park Zone) Button
Pressing the Call Park (Automatic Park Zone) button parks a call in an idle parking zone
automatically. A flexible button can be customised as the Call Park (Automatic Park Zone)
button.
Call Park Retrieve Deny
If an extension user cannot call certain extensions on a COS basis ( 1.1.2.2 Internal Call
Block), he cannot retrieve the parked call which the extensions made.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.2 Holding a Call

134

Feature Guide

Status

1.12 Holding Features

1.12.3 Call Splitting
Description
An extension user can alternate between two other parties. Placing the current call on hold
allows the user to have a conversation with the other party.

Conditions
•

While having a conversation with one party, the other party is in Consultation Hold.
(Consultation Hold: Allows an extension user to place a call on hold temporarily to
perform Call Transfer, Conference, or Call Splitting.)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.3 Talking to Two Parties Alternately (Call Splitting)

Feature Guide

135

1.12 Holding Features

1.12.4 Music on Hold
Description
Music can be played to any party on hold. The following music sources are available:

a) Internal music source
b) External music source
c) Cyclic tone
[KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200]
BGM number (1 or 2) or cyclic tone can be selected for the Music on Hold ( Music on Hold
[711]).
BGM numbers are the same as the external music port numbers (e.g., External music port 1
is BGM1.) However BGM2 includes internal music sources 1 and 2 as well as external music
port 2. It is possible to choose what music source will be used as BGM2 ( Music Source
Selection for BGM (with the KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30)/BGM2 (with the KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200)
[710]).
[BGM Number and the Music Source]
BGM No.

Music Source

1

External music port 1

2

External music port 2/Internal music source 1 or 2

[KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30]
BGM or cyclic tone can be selected for the Music on Hold ( Music on Hold [711]).
BGM includes internal music sources 1, 2 and external music port. It is possible to choose what
music source will be used as BGM ( Music Source Selection for BGM (with the KX-TDA15/
KX-TDA30)/BGM2 (with the KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200) [710]).

Conditions
•
•
•

Hardware Requirement: User-supplied music source
Volume Control
It is possible to change the volume of an internal and/or external music source.
It is possible to choose a different music source for each tenant. ( 2.2.3 Tenant Service)

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.11.1 Connection of Peripherals

6.10.1 Connection of Peripherals

136

Feature Guide

1.13 Conference Features

1.13 Conference Features
1.13.1 Conference Features
1.13.1.1 Conference Features—SUMMARY
Description
A conference call allows a conversation between three or more parties simultaneously. The
following features are available to establish a conference call:
Feature

Description

Details in

Conference

During a two-party conversation, an extension user can • 1.13.1.2
add other parties to establish a conference call with up Conference
to eight parties.

Executive Busy
Override

An extension user can interrupt an existing call to
establish a three-party conference call.

Privacy Release

During a conversation with an outside party on the S- • 1.13.1.3
CO button, a PT/PS user can allow another extension to Privacy
join the conversation.
Release

• 1.7.2
Executive
Busy
Override

Conditions
•

One PBX supports a maximum of 32 simultaneous calls which are engaged in conference
calls. (e.g., 4 eight-party conferences, 8 three-party conferences + 2 four-party
conferences, 10 three-party conferences)

Feature Guide

137

1.13 Conference Features

1.13.1.2 Conference
Description
This PBX supports three through eight-party conference calls. During a two-party
conversation, an extension user can add other parties to their conversation, thereby
establishing a conference. More than four-party conferences are only possible when a PT user
originates the conference.
Unattended Conference:
A PT user can leave a conference to allow other parties to continue the conversation. The user
may return to the conference, if he desires.

Conditions
•

•

CONF (Conference) Button
For a PT which does not have the CONF button, a flexible button can be customised as
the Conference button.
Unattended Conference Call Duration
The call duration can be restricted by the Unattended Conference Recall time. The
Unattended Conference Recall time consists of the following programmable timers:

a) Unattended Conference Recall Start Time:
When the timer expires, Unattended Conference Recall starts to be heard at the
conference originator. If the originator does not return to the conference, 1st
Unattended Conference Recall Continuation time will start.

b) 1st Unattended Conference Recall Continuation Time:
When the timer expires, an alarm tone starts to be heard at parties in the Unattended
Conference. If the originator does not return to the conference, 2nd Unattended
Conference Recall Continuation time will start.

c) 2nd Unattended Conference Recall Continuation Time:

•

When the timer expires, the Unattended Conference call is disconnected.
If the originator returns to the conference before the Unattended Conference call is
disconnected, the timer will be cancelled. If not, Unattended Conference Recall and an
alarm tone will continue to be emitted until the Unattended Conference call is
disconnected.
For Six or More Party Conference
The ECHO card is required. Also the Echocanceller should be enabled through system
programming.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.6.4 ECHO16 Card

6.5.3 ECHO8 Card

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

138

Feature Guide

1.13 Conference Features

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.5 Multiple Party Conversation

Feature Guide

139

1.13 Conference Features

1.13.1.3 Privacy Release
Description
By default, all conversations which take place on trunk, extension lines and doorphone lines
are protected by privacy (Automatic Privacy).
Privacy Release allows a PT/PS user to suspend Automatic Privacy for an existing trunk call
on the S-CO button in order to establish a three-party call.
System programming is required to enable or disable this feature.

Conditions
•
•
•

S-CO Button
A flexible button can be customised as the S-CO button.
Privacy Release Time
Privacy is released for five seconds to allow the conversation to be joined.
This feature overrides Data Line Security ( 1.10.5 Data Line Security) and Executive
Busy Override Deny ( 1.7.2 Executive Busy Override).

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.5 Multiple Party Conversation

140

Feature Guide

1.14 Paging Features

1.14 Paging Features
1.14.1 Paging
Description
An extension user can make a voice announcement to many people simultaneously.
The message is announced over the built-in speakers of PT and/or external speakers (external
pagers) which belong to the paging group. (With the KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200, up to two
external pagers can be connected; with the KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30, one external pager can be
connected.)
The paged person can answer the page from a nearby telephone.
It is possible to page with a call on hold in order to transfer the call.
Paging Deny:
It is possible to deny being paged on an extension basis.

Paging Group
Each paging group consists of user groups and external pagers. One user group or
external pager can belong to several paging groups.
( 2.2.2 Group)
[Example]
Paging Group 01

Paging Group 02

Paging Group 03

User Group 1

User Group 2

User Group 3

Extn. 100 Extn. 101

Extn. 102 Extn. 103

Extn. 104 Extn. 105

Pager 1

Paging Group 04

Pager 2

Feature Guide

141

1.14 Paging Features

[Programming Example]
Paging Group
No.

User Group No.*1
001

002

003

External Pager No.*2
...

01

...

02

...

03

...

04

...

05

...

:

:

:

:

...

1

2

:

:

: Constituent
*1:
User Groups of a Paging Group [640]
*2:
External Pagers of a Paging Group [641]

Conditions
•

Extensions which cannot be paged are:
–
–
–
–
–

•

•

•

PSs
SLTs
Ringing or busy PTs
PTs in Paging Deny mode
PTs in Paging DND mode

These extensions cannot be paged but can answer the page.
External Pager Priority
External pagers can be used with the following priorities:
TAFAS
Paging
BGM
( 1.16.3 Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS), 1.16.4 Background Music (BGM))
Volume Control
Paging volume from the PTs and the external pagers can be changed through system
programming.
Paging DND
When DND ( 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND)) is set for incoming calls, it is programmable
whether your extension receives paging through system programming.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.6.1 Paging
1.6.2 Answering/Denying a Paging Announcement

142

Feature Guide

1.15 Broadcasting Features (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

1.15 Broadcasting Features (KX-TDA30/KXTDA100/KX-TDA200 only)
1.15.1 Broadcasting (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200
only)
Description
A PT user can call multiple parties, assigned as members of a group (broadcasting group), to
make a voice announcement. After one member answers the call, the caller can begin to make
an announcement. Other members' telephones will continue to ring, and each member can
listen to the announcement by answering the call. The caller will hear a confirmation tone every
time the members answer the call.
During the announcement, the voices of members will not be heard. However, the caller can
allow specific members to speak, making a conference call. A maximum of four-party
conference call can be established. This conversation can be heard by the other members.

Broadcasting Group
There are eight broadcasting group, and a maximum of 31 members can be assigned to
each group. The available destinations as members of the broadcasting group are as
follows:
Destination

Availability

Wired Extension (PT/SLT/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX)
PS
Incoming Call Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
VM Group (DTMF/DPT)
External Pager (TAFAS)
DISA
Analogue/ISDN Remote Maintenance
Idle Line Access no. + Phone no.
Trunk Group Access no. + Trunk Group no. +
Phone no.

*

Other PBX Extension (TIE with no PBX Code)

*

Other PBX Extension (TIE with PBX Code)

*

*: Only available when the networking type of the trunk is assigned as private.

Conference Call
The caller can allow members to speak, and can control the conversation using the following
buttons. Pressing the other buttons during the conversation will be ignored.

Feature Guide

143

1.15 Broadcasting Features (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

Button

Function

DSS

Establishes a conversation with the corresponding member
extension, or remove the extension from the conversation.

CONF (Conference)

Establishes a conversation with the current members in the order
assigned in the broadcasting group. Pressing this button again
will add the next available member in the group to the
conversation.

TRANSFER

Removes the member who joined the conversation last. The
member can still listen to the announcement.

FLASH/RECALL
(Flash/Recall mode)

Removes the member who joined the conversation last. The
member will be disconnected from the broadcasting call and hear
a reorder tone.

SP-PHONE

Enables a hands-free conversation.

A member extension can inform to the caller that he wants to speak or join the conversation by
sending a notification. The caller will hear a notification tone and the requesting extension’s
information will be shown on the display for five seconds.

Conditions
•
•
•

•
•
•
•
•
•

Hardware Requirement: The MEC card
COS programming determines the extensions (PTs only) that can use this feature.
Ring Duration
A system timer is available to limit the call ring duration at the members. When this limit is
reached, members' telephones will stop ringing. If no members have answered the call,
the caller will hear a busy tone.
The broadcasting call will reach a member extension regardless of settings such as Call
Forwarding (except DND).
If a member extension is busy and has Call Waiting for trunk calls activated when a
broadcasting call is made, a call waiting tone will be sent to the extension.
The call information of the caller (not members) will be recorded on the SMDR.
A caller cannot make a broadcasting call with a call on hold.
Call Pickup is not available for a broadcasting call. ( 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup)
The broadcasting call will not reach members when:
– the member extension has set DND for intercom calls.
– the member extension is a PS in Wireless XDP Parallel Mode. (
Wireless XDP Parallel Mode)

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.3.2 MEC Card

6.5.6 MEC Card

144

Feature Guide

1.24.5

1.15 Broadcasting Features (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.6.3 Making an Announcement and Having a Multiple Party Conversation
(Broadcasting)(KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

Feature Guide

145

1.16 Optional Device Features

1.16 Optional Device Features
1.16.1 Doorphone Call
Description
A visitor using a doorphone will call a preprogrammed destination (extension or outside party).
Extension users can call a doorphone.

Conditions
•

•
•

•
•
•

•

•

•
•

Hardware Requirement:
KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200: An optional Doorphone, the OPB card and DPH card
KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30: An optional Doorphone and the DPH card
Each doorphone port must be assigned to one tenant. The Time Table (day/lunch/break/
night) of the tenant applies. ( 2.2.4 Time Service)
Call Destination
The incoming doorphone call destination(s) can be assigned for each time mode (day/
lunch/break/night) for each doorphone port ( Doorphone Call Destination [720]).
Destinations can be selected. ( 1.1.2.1 Internal Call Features—SUMMARY)
COS programming determines the doorphone ports that are able to make an outgoing
trunk call.
Internal Call Block determines which extensions can call a doorphone. ( 1.1.2.2 Internal
Call Block)
Ring Duration
If an incoming call is not answered within a preprogrammed time period, ringing stops and
the call is cancelled.
Call Duration
The call duration can be restricted by a system timer. If the timer expires, the call will be
disconnected.
Door Open
While engaged on a doorphone call, the extension user can unlock the door to let the
visitor in. ( 1.16.2 Door Open)
A doorphone number can be referenced for each doorphone port ( Doorphone Number
Reference [729]).
KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30 only
Doorphones 1 and 2 (or 3 and 4) cannot make a call simultaneously. If a visitor presses
the doorphone button while the other doorphone is engaged in a call, he will hear no tone.
Doorphones 1 and 2 (or 3 and 4) cannot receive a call simultaneously. If an extension user
calls a doorphone while the other doorphone is engaged in a call, he will hear a busy tone.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.6.1 OPB3 Card
2.6.2 DPH4 Card
2.6.3 DPH2 Card

146

Feature Guide

1.16 Optional Device Features

2.10.1 Connection of Doorphones and Door Openers

6.5.1 DPH4 Card
6.5.2 DPH2 Card
6.9.1 Connection of Doorphones and Door Openers

User Manual References
User Manual
1.9.1 If a Doorphone/Door Opener is Connected

Feature Guide

147

1.16 Optional Device Features

1.16.2 Door Open
Description
An extension user can unlock the door for a visitor using his telephone.
The door can be unlocked by extension users who are allowed to unlock the door in the COS
programming ( Permission for Door Open Access [512]). However, while engaged on a
doorphone call, any extension user can unlock the door to let the visitor in ( 1.16.1
Doorphone Call).

Conditions
•
•
•

Hardware Requirement: A user-supplied door opener on each door.
The door opener will unlock the door even if a doorphone is not installed.
Door Open Duration
The door can remain unlocked for a preprogrammed time period ( Door Open Duration
Time [207]).

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.10.1 Connection of Doorphones and Door Openers

6.9.1 Connection of Doorphones and Door Openers

User Manual References
User Manual
1.9.1 If a Doorphone/Door Opener is Connected

148

Feature Guide

1.16 Optional Device Features

1.16.3 Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS)
Description
A ring tone is sent through the external pager when an incoming call is received. Any extension
user can answer the call.

Conditions
•
•

•

Hardware Requirement: A user-supplied external pager
Floating Extension Number
A floating extension number can be assigned for an external pager ( External Pager
Floating Extension Number [700]). It is possible to access an external pager by dialling
their floating extension numbers.
Pager Volume
It is possible to change the volume of an external pager through system programming.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.11.1 Connection of Peripherals

6.10.1 Connection of Peripherals

User Manual References
User Manual
1.3.4 Answering a Call via an External Speaker (Trunk Answer From Any Station [TAFAS])

Feature Guide

149

1.16 Optional Device Features

1.16.4 Background Music (BGM)
Description
A PT user can listen to BGM through the built-in speaker while on-hook and idle.
BGM—External:
BGM can also be broadcast in the office through the external pagers, this can be turned on and
off by an extension assigned as the manager.

Conditions
[BGM]
•
•
•
•

Hardware requirement: A user-supplied external music source, such as a radio
The music through the PT is interrupted when going off-hook.
KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only
Each user can set/cancel BGM, and also select the music source.
KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30 only
Each user can only set/cancel BGM; the user cannot make a music selection.

[BGM—External]
•
•

Hardware requirement: A user-supplied external pager
External pagers can be used with the following priorities:
TAFAS
Paging
BGM
( 1.14.1 Paging, 1.16.3 Trunk Answer From Any Station (TAFAS))

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.11.1 Connection of Peripherals

6.10.1 Connection of Peripherals

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.8 Turning on the Background Music (BGM)
2.1.4 Turning on the External Background Music (BGM)

150

Feature Guide

1.16 Optional Device Features

1.16.5 Outgoing Message (OGM)
Description
An extension assigned as the manager (manager extension) can record outgoing messages
(OGMs) for the following features:
Feature

Usage

Details in

Direct Inward System
Access (DISA)

When a call arrives on a DISA line, the caller will • 1.16.6 Direct
hear a message.
Inward
System
Access
(DISA)

Queuing Feature

• 1.2.2.3
If assigned in the Queuing Time Table of the
incoming call distribution group ( Sequences in Queuing
Feature
Queuing Time Table [631]), any caller who is
waiting in a queue will hear a message.

Timed Reminder

When answering the Timed Reminder Alarm, the • 1.26.4
user will hear a message.
Timed
Reminder

Conditions
•

•

•
•

Hardware Requirement:
KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200: The OPB card and MSG card
KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30: The MSG card
The Number of Messages and the Recording Time
A maximum of 64 (with the KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200) or 32 (with the KX-TDA15/KXTDA30) messages can be recorded. The recording time per message is a maximum of
one minute. However the total recording time in the PBX is 8 minutes.
A floating extension number can be assigned to each outgoing message (OGM) (
Outgoing Message (OGM) Floating Extension Number [730]).
One MSG card allows 4 (with the KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200) or 2 (with the KX-TDA15/KXTDA30) messages to play simultaneously. The MSG card expansion does not increase the
total recording time or the number of messages. It increases the number of messages that
can be played simultaneously.
[Example]
Up to 4 (with the KXTDA100/KX-TDA200) or 2
(with the KX-TDA15/KXTDA30) messages can be
played simultaneously to
callers.

Up to 8 (with the KXTDA100/KX-TDA200) or 4
(with the KX-TDA15/KXTDA30) messages can be
played simultaneously to
callers.

PBX

PBX
MSG
Card
Total message recording time:
8 minutes max.

MSG
Card

MSG
Card

Total message recording time:
8 minutes max.

Feature Guide

151

1.16 Optional Device Features

Note
When MSG card expansion has been completed, the new MSG card is blank—all
necessary messages will need to be stored in the card. This can be done in two ways:

a) By installing the new MSG card then recording each message again. The PBX
will automatically store the new recordings in each MSG card.

b) By transferring messages from the PBX to a personal computer (PC) using the

•
•

Maintenance Console, then transferring them back to the PBX with the new MSG
card installed.
The same message can also be played simultaneously to multiple callers.
Recording Methods

a) Record voice messages through the extension telephone
b) Transfer prerecorded voice messages from external sound source into the PBX via an
external music port.
Note
Record voice messages only; avoid the recording of music.
•
•

•
•

After recording messages, a manager extension can also play them back for confirmation.
Progress tone is sent to a manager extension before recording messages during a
preprogrammed time period, or during clearing the prerecorded message stored at the
floating extension number of desired message. The longer one is applied.
Record a message when traffic is light (early morning or late evening).
When the manager tries to record a message, he will hear ringback tone if a message
channel is in use. When all ports of the MSG card(s) become idle, he will hear the progress
tone for a preprogrammed time period.
After that, the PBX will automatically proceed into the recording mode.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.6.1 OPB3 Card
2.6.5 MSG4 Card

6.5.4 MSG2 Card

User Manual References
User Manual
2.1.5 Recording Outgoing Messages (OGM)

152

Feature Guide

1.16 Optional Device Features

1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
Description
An outside caller can access specific PBX features as if the caller is an SLT extension user on
the PBX, when the incoming call destination is a DISA floating extension number assigned to
each DISA message. The caller can have direct access to features such as:
•
Placing an intercom call to an extension, operator or any floating extensions (e.g.,
modem for remote system administration, an external pager for TAFAS).
•
Calling an outside party via the PBX.
•
Operating some PBX remote features (e.g., FWD)

Outgoing Message (OGM)
When a call arrives on a DISA line, a prerecorded DISA message will greet and guide the
caller.
Any extension assigned as the manager can record outgoing messages (OGMs). ( 1.16.5
Outgoing Message (OGM))

DISA Intercept—No Dial
If the caller fails to dial any digits within a preprogrammed time period (DISA 1st Dial Time for
Intercept) ( DISA Intercept Time [211]) following the outgoing message (OGM), the call is
redirected to the operator extension.

DISA Built-in Automated Attendant Number (DISA AA Service)
After listening to the outgoing message (OGM), the caller may dial a single digit (DISA AA
number). The destination for each DISA AA number can be assigned for each message. It is
also possible to assign other DISA floating extension number as the destination (Multistep
DISA AA Service).
If the caller dials a second digit within a preprogrammed time period (DISA 2nd Dial Time for
AA), the DISA AA service is not employed.

DISA Security Mode and Available Features
If the DISA AA service is not employed, the caller may access the PBX features by entering
the feature numbers. To prevent others from accessing the PBX features, it is possible to
assign DISA security ( DISA Security Mode [732]). The features available depend on the
preprogrammed DISA security mode as follows:

Feature Guide

153

1.16 Optional Device Features

TIE Line Call
Security
Mode

Intercom
Call

Without PBX
Code

With PBX
Code

Trunk Call

All
Security
Trunk
Security
No
Security

*

: Available
*:
If trunk call is available, Account Code Entry (
available.
Note
DISA AA service and Operator Call (
security mode.

1.5.4.3 Account Code Entry) is also

2.2.5 Operator Features) are available for any

Security Mode Override:
If the caller operates with the following features while hearing a DISA message, the security
mode can be changed to the No Security mode temporarily:
•
Walking COS ( 1.8.5 Walking COS): Walking COS feature number + extension
number + extension personal identification number (PIN)
•
Verified Code Entry ( 1.8.6 Verified Code Entry): Verified Code Entry feature
number + + verified code + verified code PIN
After changing mode, the mode remains in force for the duration of the call.
Available PBX Features with Security Mode Override:
After Security Mode Override is done with the Walking COS feature, the following features are
available (It regards a remote operation from the assigned extension [ 1.26.5 Remote
Extension Control by User]):
•
FWD
•
DND
•
Log-in/Log-out ( 1.2.2.6 Log-in/Log-out)
•
Absent Message ( 1.18.2 Absent Message)
•
Extension Lock ( 1.8.3 Extension Lock)
•
Time Service Switching Mode ( 2.2.4 Time Service)

DISA Intercept Routing—Busy/DND
If the destination called by the outside party is busy or in DND mode, and if (1) the busy
destination does not set Call Waiting, FWD, or Idle Extension Hunting or (2) the destination is
in DND mode and Idle Extension Hunting is not available, one of the following can be selected
through system programming:

a) Busy Tone: Busy tone is sent to the caller.

154

Feature Guide

1.16 Optional Device Features

b) Intercept Routing: Intercept Routing—Busy/DND will work and the call will be
redirected to the preprogrammed destination.

c) Outgoing Message (OGM): An outgoing message (OGM) will be sent to the caller.
The message for busy/DND mode can be assigned for each outgoing message
(OGM) which has a DISA floating extension number.

DISA Intercept Routing—No Answer
If a destination is not available to answer a DISA call within a preprogrammed time period
(DISA Intercept time) ( DISA Intercept Time [211]) after the call is reached, the call will be
redirected to the programmed destination by the Intercept feature ( Trunk Group Intercept
Destination [470] or Extension Intercept Destination [604]).
If the intercept destination is not available to answer the call within a preprogrammed time
period (DISA Disconnect Time after Intercept) after the DISA Intercept time expires, the call
will be disconnected.

SMDR
The call information for DISA is recorded as the one of the DISA floating extension numbers.
( 1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR))

[Programming Example]
The following items can be assigned to each outgoing message (OGM):
Outgoing
Message
(OGM) No.

Floating
Extn.
No.*1

01

300

02

301

:

:

*1:

Automated Attendant No.
0

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

100 301 200 103 202 101 102 400 104 205

Busy/DND
Message No.
04
05

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

Outgoing Message (OGM) Floating Extension Number [730]

Feature Guide

155

1.16 Optional Device Features

[Flowchart]

A DISA call from an outside party is received.

No

Is there an idle port on the
MSG cards?

Yes

(DISA Delayed Answer Time
Time-out)

The PBX answers the call.

Does the trunk group that
received the call employ Intercept
Routing Busy DND?

(DISA Mute Time
Time-out)

A

Yes
The call is routed to the intercept
destination.

The outgoing message (OGM) plays and
the PBX starts to receive the DTMF signalling.

F
No
Is the first digit dialled?
(DISA 1st Dial Time for
Intercept Time-out)
Yes

The call is routed to the Operator.
(Intercept Routing No Destination)

The outgoing message (OGM) stops.

Goes to

C

No
Is the second digit dialled?
(DISA 2nd Dial Time for
AA Time-out)
Yes
No
The PBX receives the following
dialled digits and checks the
dialled number.

Is the first dialled digit assigned a
destination for the DISA AA service?
Yes
The call is routed to the destination.

What is the DISA security mode?

Continued to the next page

156

Feature Guide

No

The call is routed
to the operator.
(Intercept Routing
No Destination)

1.16 Optional Device Features

Continued from the previous page

No
Security
None

B

Trunk Security

All Security

Is the dialled number
an extension number or
floating extension number?

No

Yes

Goes to

Is the Walking COS/Verified
Code Entry feature number dialled
for Security Mode Override?

C

What is the dialled number?

Goes to

D

Is the correct
personal identification number
(PIN) entered?

Extension No./
Floating
Extension No.

Feature No.*
(e.g., FWD)

Trunk Access No.
+ Telephone No.

Others

No

Yes

No

D
B

Goes to

Reorder tone

The feature is set.

Yes

C

The dialled number is sent to the trunk.

Is the extension idle?

Does the caller press
while hearing reorder
tone (Call Retry)?

No

Yes
Yes

Is the extension
busy (Call Waiting
mode on) and is
not in DND mode?

E
The extension
receives the call.

Goes to

A

The call is disconnected.

The call waits
to be received.

Does the caller press
while hearing a ringback
tone (Call Retry)?

The extension
becomes idle.

Yes
Does the
destination
answer
the call?

Goes to

A

Goes to

E

What method is assigned
for DISA Intercept
Routing Busy/DND?

Intercept Routing

The call is established.

The call is routed to the
intercept destination.
(DISA Intercept Routing
No Answer)

Does the caller press
while hearing busy
tone (Call Retry)?
(Busy Tone
Time Time-out)
Yes

The call is disconnected.
Goes to

The call is established.

A

The call is routed to
the intercept destination.
(Intercept Routing Busy/DND)

Does the destination
No
answer the call?
(DISA Disconnect
Time after Intercept
Yes
Time-out)

Outgoing
Message
(OGM)

Busy Tone

No

No (DISA Intercept Time
Time-out)

Yes

(DISA Reorder Tone
Duration Time
Time-out)

No

Yes

No

No

Goes to

The message for
the busy/DND mode
is sent to the caller.

Goes to

F

E

The call is disconnected.

*: Feature numbers are available only when the Walking COS feature is used for Security Mode Override.

Feature Guide

157

1.16 Optional Device Features

Conditions
WARNING
When you enable the Trunk-to-Trunk Call feature of DISA, and a third party discovers the
personal identification number (PIN) (verified code PIN/extension PIN) of the PBX, there
will be a risk that they will make fraudulent phone calls using the telephone line, and the
cost will be charged to your own account. In order to avoid this problem, we strongly
recommend the following points:

a) Carefully maintain the secrecy of the PIN.
b) Specify a complicated PIN as long and random as you can make it.
c) Change the PIN frequently.
•

•

•

•

•

Hardware Requirement:
KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200: The OPB card and MSG card
KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30: The MSG card
DISA Delayed Answer Time
It is possible to set the Delayed Answer time ( DISA Delayed Answer Time [209]) so that
the caller will hear a ringback tone within a preprogrammed time period first before hearing
an outgoing message (OGM).
DISA Mute Time
It is possible to set the Mute time until the outgoing message (OGM) plays and the PBX
starts to receive the DTMF signalling after the caller reaches the DISA line.
Trunk-to-Trunk Call Duration
If a call between two outside parties is established, the call duration can be restricted by
a system timer. ( 1.10.8 Trunk Call Limitation) If the timer expires, the line will be
disconnected unless the originating caller retries by pressing " " or extends the time by
sending any DTMF signalling. The caller can prolong the call duration within the
preprogrammed time period ( DISA Trunk-to-Trunk Call Prolong Time [210]) and
preprogramming number of times.
Tone Detection
The following three types of tone detection can be enabled for each trunk group to
disconnect a trunk-to-trunk call via DISA.
– Silence Detection ( DISA Silence Detection [475])
– Continuous Signal Detection ( DISA Continuous Signal Detection [476])
– Cyclic Signal Detection ( DISA Cyclic Signal Detection [477])

•

•

•
•

158

Feature Guide

Call Retry
While hearing a ringback, reorder, or busy tone, retrying the call is possible by pressing
" ". During a trunk-to-trunk conversation, the result of pressing " " is programmable:
retry mode or DTMF mode.
DISA Reorder Tone Duration
It is possible to set the DISA Reorder Tone Duration time. Reorder tone will be sent to the
caller for a preprogrammed time period. When the timer expires the call will be
disconnected. Retrying the call is possible by pressing " " during the DISA Reorder Tone
Duration time.
Call Deny
Extensions can deny DISA calls on a COS basis.
Verified Code PIN Lock/Extension PIN Lock
If the wrong PIN is entered incorrectly three times, the line will be disconnected. If the
incorrect PIN is entered a preprogrammed number of times successively, the PIN against

1.16 Optional Device Features

•

the verified code or the extension will be locked. Only an extension assigned as the
manager can unlock it. In this case, the PIN will be unlocked and will be cleared.
Each outgoing message (OGM) call have a name through system programming (
Outgoing Message (OGM) Name [731]) for programming reference.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.6.1 OPB3 Card
2.6.5 MSG4 Card

6.5.4 MSG2 Card

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing
1.1.1.7 Intercept Routing—No Destination
1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.8 To Access Another Party Directly from Outside (Direct Inward System Access
[DISA])
1.2.9 Setting Your Telephone from Another Extension or through DISA (Remote Setting)

Feature Guide

159

1.17 Caller ID Features

1.17 Caller ID Features
1.17.1 Caller ID
Description
The PBX receives caller’s information, such as the caller’s name and telephone number, on
trunks assigned to receive Caller ID. A display PT user can see the information.
The PBX can modify the received number according to preprogrammed tables so that he can
call back or memorise it. For example, if the area code is sent and it is not required to return
the call, store the area code in the table so that the area code is deleted automatically.
Caller ID to SLT Port (KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30 only):
An SLT user can also see the caller’s information. This feature is available only for SLTs
compatible with FSK type Caller ID.
Note
This feature complies with ETSI (European Telecommunications Standards Institute) type
FSK and Bellcore type FSK.

1. Features
Caller ID includes the following features:
Feature
Caller ID (KXTDA30/KX-TDA100/
KX-TDA200 only)

Feature Guide

Caller’s information which is sent from
an analogue trunk.
The following Caller ID signalling types are
supported: FSK and DTMF.

Details in
–

Calling Line
Caller’s information which is sent from
Identification
an ISDN line.
Presentation (CLIP)

• 1.20.1.2
Calling/
Connected Line
Identification
Presentation
(CLIP/COLP)

Caller’s information which is sent from
an E1 or T1 line.

• 1.21.1 E1 Line
Service (KXTDA100/KXTDA200 only)
• 1.22.1 T1 Line
Service (KXTDA100/KXTDA200 only)

Automatic Number
Identification (ANI)
(KX-TDA100/KXTDA200 only)

160

Description

1.17 Caller ID Features

2. Service Features
Features

Description

Details in

Calling Line
Identification (CLI)
Distribution

Directs a DIL/DID/DDI/MSN call to a CLI
destination if the caller’s identification (Caller
ID/CLIP/ANI) has been assigned to the Caller
ID Table.

• 1.1.1.5 Calling
Line
Identification
(CLI)
Distribution

Incoming Call Log

Caller’s information is automatically recorded • 1.17.2
Incoming Call
in the call log of the called extension. This
information is used for confirming the caller, Log
calling the caller back, and/or storing the
number and name in the Personal Speed
Dialling.

3. Number/Name Assignment
3.1 Automatic Caller ID Number Modification
This PBX automatically modifies the incoming caller’s number according to
preprogrammed tables. The modified number will be recorded for calling back.
The PBX supports a number of modification tables, and each trunk group can select
a table for use. Each table has ten locations for local/international calls and one for
long distance calls.
The PBX checks the local/international call data first. If a match is not found, the long
distance call data is applied.
[Example]

Trunk
Modification
Group No.
Table
1
1
2
3
:
:


Modification Table 1
Area Code Removed No. of Digits Added No.
Local/International
Blank
3
012
Call Data 1
Local/International
001
2
00
Call Data 2
:
:
:
:
Local/International
Call Data 10
Not
Long Distance Call
0
0
programmable
Data 1

Note
When caller’s information is sent through an ISDN line and the call type is Subscriber,
National, or International, the following modification table is used instead of the above
table:

Removed No. of Digits Added No.
Subscriber Call Data

0

Blank

National Call Data

0

0

International Call Data

0

00

Feature Guide

161

1.17 Caller ID Features


A trunk call with the caller's
information is received.

Checks the Table Selection.
Table 1
Is the area code found in
local/international call data
in the modification table?

Yes:
e.g., 00987654321
Checks the local/
international call data.

No:
e.g., 3344556677

Checks the long distance call data.

Matches (Data 2)
Modifies the number as programmed.

Removed number of digits: 2
Added number: 001
Received number: 00987654321

Modifies the number as programmed.
(Removed number of digits: 0,
Added number: 0)

Modified number: 00987654321 = 001987654321
1) Remove the
first 2 digits.

2) Add "001".

Modification is completed:
001987654321.

Modification is completed:
03344556677.

3.2 Caller ID Table Assignment
The System Speed Dialling Table is also used as the Caller ID Table.
In each location of the table, the following items can be assigned:
a) Telephone number (Trunk Access number + caller’s telephone number)
b) System Speed Dialling name (caller’s name)
(shown on the display or SMDR)
c) CLI destination
(used for CLI feature)
When a caller’s modified telephone number matches a telephone number (the Trunk
Access number is disregarded.) in the table, the call is sent to the assigned CLI
destination.

162

Feature Guide

1.17 Caller ID Features

[Example]
Location
(System Speed
Dialling No.)

Telephone No.*1

System Speed Dialling
Name*2

CLI
Destination

000

90123456789

ABC Company

200

001

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

*1:
*2:

System Speed Dialling Number [001]
System Speed Dialling Name [002]

3.3 Caller’s Name Reference
A name can also be shown on the display or SMDR. The PBX searches for the name
in the following order:
1) Personal Speed Dialling data of the original called extension
2) System Speed Dialling (Caller ID) Table
3) Caller ID name received from the public line (Caller ID Name Reference)
If the name is not found, it will not be displayed.

Conditions
[General]
•
•
•

Caller ID signalling type can be selected through system programming ( Caller ID Signal
Type [490] (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)).
The Caller ID Name Reference is only available for calls from the public network.
For Users in New Zealand only
Using the toll services of a company other than Telecom NZ.
If the PBX is set up to use the toll services of a company other than Telecom NZ, the
telephone numbers dialled from the Caller Display listings within the PBX will be directed
through the toll services of the other company because the telephone numbers include the
toll access digit and area code digit. A toll charge may be incurred. Please check with the
toll carrier concerned.

[Caller ID to SLT Port (KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30 only)]
•
•

•
•
•

•

Hardware Requirement: The EXT-CID card
Through system programming, a group of 4 SLT or Super Hybrid ports can be assigned
to receive Caller ID. Up to 2 groups can be programmed. Therefore, a maximum of 8 SLTs
can receive Caller ID.
When the caller’s number is sent to an SLT, a Trunk Access number can be automatically
added to the telephone number through system programming for calling back.
When the caller’s number exceeds 16 digits, the SLT receives only the first 16 digits, not
counting the preceding Trunk Access number (if it is programmed to be added).
If a call is transferred to an SLT, the transferring extension’s information will be shown on
the SLT. If the transferring extension goes on-hook, the original caller’s information will be
shown.
When the Caller ID has information, such as private, out of area, or long distance, the
information will be shown instead of the caller’s number and name.

Feature Guide

163

1.17 Caller ID Features

•
•
•

For an SLT that is connected to a DPT in parallel, Caller ID information is available only
when the SLT is set to "ring".
Even if the caller’s name is sent, the name may not be shown depending on the type of
SLT.
Incoming Call Log information is not shown on the SLT.

Feature Guide References
1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System
1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)

164

Feature Guide

1.17 Caller ID Features

1.17.2 Incoming Call Log
Description
When an incoming public trunk call with the caller’s information (e.g., Caller ID) is directed to
an extension, the information is automatically recorded in the call log of the called extension.
This information is shown on the telephone display and is used for confirming the caller, calling
back, or storing the number and name in the Personal Speed Dialling.
[Example]
--- Caller's name (20 digits max.)
--- Caller's number (16 digits max.)
--- Date and time of a call received
--- Answering Status*

John White
123456789
12 Dec.10:00AM MON
New: Not Answered

Call Log buttons
Own extension
Incoming call distribution group

*: "New" is displayed for call records which have not previously been viewed;
"Old" is displayed for call records which have previously been viewed.

Conditions
•

Call Log Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Call Log button for the extension or an incoming
call distribution group. The button light shows the current status as follows:
Light pattern

•

•

•

Status

Red on

There is unchecked information.

Off

All information has been checked.

If the answering destination is not the original extension (FWD—No Answer,
Intercept Routing—No Answer, Overflow, and Call Pickup):
If a call is forwarded because of no answer or another extension picks up the call, the
information is logged in the call logs of both the original destination and the answering
destination. If a call is forwarded to several extensions before answered, the information is
logged in the call logs for all the forwarded extensions. If a call is forwarded to an incoming
call distribution group and is not answered, the information is not logged in the call log for
the incoming call distribution group.
Call Log for Incoming Call Distribution Group Calls
If the original destination of a call is an incoming call distribution group, and the call is not
answered, the information is logged in the call log for the group. If it is answered, the
information is logged in the call log for the answering extension.
Call Log for PS Calls
If a PS or a CS is in one of the following situations when a call arrives, the information is
logged in the call log for the PS:

Feature Guide

165

1.17 Caller ID Features

a) When the PS is out of range.
b) When the PS is turned off.
c) When the CS is busy.
•

•

•

Incoming Call Log Display Lock
An extension user can lock the Incoming Call Log display to prevent other users from
referring to the call information at his extension through personal programming (Directory
and Call Log Lock). In this case, the Outgoing Call Log display and the Personal Speed
Dialling number display is also locked. An extension personal identification number (PIN)
is required to use this feature. ( 1.26.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN))
Storing the Call Log Information in Personal Speed Dialling
When storing the number and name into Personal Speed Dialling from the call log
information, the Idle Line Access number is automatically attached to the telephone
number.
Incoming Call Log Memory
The total memory for the Incoming Call Log is determined in the PBX. The maximum
number that can be logged for each extension and incoming call distribution group is also
determined through system programming. If the memory becomes full, the new call record
overwrites the oldest one.

Feature Guide References
1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.11.1 Using the Call Log
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

166

Feature Guide

1.18 Message Features

1.18 Message Features
1.18.1 Message Waiting
Description
An extension user can notify another extension user that he wishes to talk to the user. The
notified extension user can return the call or listen to the messages left in his mailbox of the
VPS.
When a message is left on a PT, the Message button on it lights or the Message/Ringer Lamp
on it turns on red. Pressing the lit Message button while on-hook shows the caller’s information
as shown below:
[Example]
105:Tom Smith

--- Extension no. and name of who left the message

Message buttons
Own extension
Incoming call distribution group
Other extension*
*: For example, this button is useful
when the secretary checks the
message for the boss (Boss &
Secretary Feature).

Conditions
•

•

•

Message Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Message button for the extension, other
extensions, or an incoming call distribution group.
Distinctive Dial Tone for Message Waiting
If the Distinctive Dial mode is enabled, dial tone 4 will be sent to an extension when a
message has been left on the extension. ( 1.27.1 Dial Tone)
SLT with a Message Waiting Lamp (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)
The lamp activates in the same way as the MESSAGE button on a PT, if an MSLC card is
connected to the PBX. The Message Waiting Lamp light pattern can be selected from the
twelve patterns shown below. System programming for each extension port is required to
use this feature.

Feature Guide

167

1.18 Message Features

[SLT Message Waiting Lamp Light Patterns]
5.12 s
1.28 s

Pattern 1

ON
OFF
5.12 s
1.28 s

Pattern 2

ON
OFF

512 ms
5.12 s
1.28 s

ON

Pattern 3

Pattern 4

OFF

256 ms
2.56 s
768 ms

ON
OFF

256 ms
5.12 s
768 ms

Pattern 5

ON
OFF
256 ms
2.56 s
512 ms

Pattern 6

ON
OFF
10.24 s
1.28 s

Pattern 7

ON
OFF

256 ms

20.48 s

1.28 s

Pattern 8

ON
OFF

256 ms

10.24 s

1.28 s

Pattern 9

ON
OFF
20.48 s

Pattern 10

168

Feature Guide

ON
OFF

1.28 s

1.18 Message Features

10.24 s

10.24 s

20.48 s

10.24 s

20.48 s

t
t=1.28 s

Pattern 11

ON
OFF
10.24 s
t
t=1.28 s

Pattern 12

ON
OFF

•
•
•
•

It is possible to set Message Waiting while hearing a ringback tone, busy tone, or DND
tone.
Messages are always left on the original extension. Messages cannot be sent to their
FWD destination ( 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)).
Both the message sending extension and receiving extension can cancel a left message.
If the message receiving extension calls the sending extension and is answered, the
message will be cleared automatically. However, if the message has been left on the VPS,
it depends on the VPS.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer
1.9.3 If a Voice Processing System is Connected

Feature Guide

169

1.18 Message Features

1.18.2 Absent Message
Description
The extension users can set the message (e.g., the reason for absence, where he is) on his
telephone. When display PT user calls the extension, the message is shown on the caller’s
telephone.
The following messages can be programmed as desired:
Type
System
message

Message
No.

Message (Example)

1

Will Return Soon

2

Gone Home

3

At Ext %%%% (Extension
Number)

4

Back at %%:%% (Hour:Minute)

5

Out until %%/%% (Month/Day)

6

In a Meeting

Description
Messages may be edited
through system programming
( Absent Message [008]).
They are used for every
extension user commonly.

7
8
Personal
message

9

A message is programmable at
each extension through
personal programming
(Personal Absent Message),
which can only be used by that
extension user.

Note
The "%" means a parameter to be entered when assigning a message at an individual
extension.
Up to seven "%"s can be stored for each message.

Conditions
•

An extension user can select only one message at a time. The selected message is
displayed at the extension while on-hook.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.5.2 Showing a Message on the Caller’s Telephone Display (Absent Message)
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

170

Feature Guide

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features
1.19.1 Fixed Buttons
Description
PTs, DSS Consoles, and Add-on Key Modules are provided with the following feature/Line
Access buttons:
Depending on your device type, some buttons may not be provided.
As for buttons on PSs, please refer to the Operating Instructions for each PS.
[PT and Add-on Key Module]
Button

Usage
Used to adjust the ringer, speaker, handset and headset
volume and the display contrast. Navigator Key and Jog Dial
can also be used to select data from the Call Directory and
the System Feature Access Menu on the display.

Navigator Key,
Jog Dial,
Volume Key

VOL

ENTER

Used to confirm the selected item.

CANCEL

Used to cancel the selected item.

PROGRAM

Used to enter and exit the programming mode.

FLASH/
RECALL

Used to disconnect the current call and make another call
without hanging up (Flash/Recall mode or Terminate mode)
or used to send a flash/recall signal to the telephone
company or host PBX to access their features (External
Feature Access mode). This button can also be used as a
CANCEL button while on-hook.

HOLD

Used to place a call on hold.

Feature Guide

171

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

Button

Usage

SP-PHONE
(Speakerphone)

Used for hands-free operation. Also used to switch between
handset and hands-free operation.

MONITOR

Used for a hands-free dialling. Also used to monitor the
party’s voice in hands-free mode.

MESSAGE

Used to leave a message waiting indication or call back the
party who left the message waiting indication.

REDIAL

Used to redial the last dialled number.

TRANSFER

Used to transfer a call to another party.

Flexible CO (Trunk)

Used to make or receive a trunk call or can be reassigned to
a different Trunk Access button (Default: S-CO) or to
another feature button.

INTERCOM

Used to make or receive intercom calls.

AUTO ANS
(Auto Answer)/
MUTE

Used to receive an incoming call in hands-free mode, or
used for microphone or handset mute during a
conversation. (Dual feature button)

VOICE CALL/
MUTE

Used to monitor an intercom call automatically (a handsfree conversation is not possible). Also used for handset
microphone mute during a conversation.

AUTO DIAL/
STORE

Used for System/Personal Speed Dialling and storing
programme changes.

CONF
(Conference)

Used to establish a multiple-party conversation.

FWD/DND

Used to perform FWD or DND. (Dual feature button)

PAUSE

Used to insert a pause in a stored number. With an APT, it
is used as the PROGRAM button.

Soft

Used to select the item displayed on the bottom line of the
display.

SELECT

Used to select the displayed item or to call the displayed
number.

SHIFT

Used to access the second level of Soft button items.

MODE

Used to shift the display to access various features.

[DSS Console]
Button

172

Usage

ANSWER

Used to answer an incoming call or place the current call on
hold and answer another call with one-touch.

RELEASE

Used to disconnect the line during or after a conversation or
to complete a Call Transfer.

Feature Guide

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

Button

Usage

Flexible CO (Trunk)

Used to make or receive a trunk call or can be reassigned to
a different trunk or to another feature button.

Flexible DSS (Direct Station
Selection)

Used to access an extension with one-touch. Every button
is programmed to correspond to an extension. DSS buttons
can also be reassigned to other features.

PF (Programmable Feature)

Used to access a preprogrammed feature with one-touch.
(no default)

Conditions
•

Certain buttons are equipped with a light to show line or feature status.

Feature Guide

173

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

1.19.2 Flexible Buttons
Description
Flexible buttons are customised by either system or personal programming. The following
types of flexible buttons are provided on PTs, DSS Consoles, Add-on Key Modules, and/or
PSs:

a) Flexible CO buttons
b) Flexible Direct Station Selection (DSS) buttons
c) Programmable Feature (PF) buttons
[Button Usage]
Button

174

Usage

Single-CO (S-CO)

Used to access a specified trunk for making or receiving calls.

Group-CO (G-CO)

Used to access an idle trunk in a specified trunk group for
making calls. Incoming calls from trunks in the assigned trunk
group arrive at this button.

Loop-CO (L-CO)

Used to access an idle trunk for making calls. Incoming calls
from any trunk arrive at this button.

Direct Station Selection
(DSS)

Used to access an extension with one-touch.

One-touch Dialling

Used to access a preprogrammed party or feature with onetouch.

Incoming Call Distribution
(ICD) Group

Used to access a specified incoming call distribution group
for making or receiving calls.

Message

Used to leave a message waiting indication or call back the
party who left the message waiting indication.

FWD/DND (External/
Internal/Both) *

Used to perform the FWD or DND feature for the extension.
The feature is applied to trunk calls, intercom calls, or both.

Group FWD (External/
Internal/Both)

Used to perform the FWD feature for a specified incoming call
distribution group. The feature is applied to trunk calls,
intercom calls, or both.

Account Code Entry
(Account)

Used to enter an account code.

Conference

Used to establish a multiparty conversation.

Terminate

Used to disconnect the current call and make another call
without hanging up.

External Feature Access
(EFA)

Used to send a flash/recall signal to the telephone company
or host PBX to access their features.

Charge Reference

Used to check the total call charge for your own extension.

Call Park

Used to park or retrieve a call in a preset PBX parking zone.

Call Park (Automatic Park
Zone)

Used to park a call in an idle PBX parking zone automatically.

Feature Guide

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

Button

Usage

Call Log

Used to show the incoming call information.

Log-in/Log-out *

Used to switch between the log-in and log-out mode.

Hurry-up

Used to redirect the longest waiting call in the queue of an
incoming call distribution group to the overflow destination.

Wrap-up *

Used to switch the Wrap-up/Not Ready and Ready modes.

System Alarm

Used to confirm a PBX error.

Time Service *

Used to switch the assigned time modes: day, lunch, break or
night. Also used to check the current time mode status.

Answer

Used to answer an incoming call.

Release

Used to disconnect the line during or after a conversation, or
to complete a Call Transfer.

Toll Restriction/Call Barring Used to change the TRS/Barring level of other extension
users temporarily.
ISDN Service

Used to access an ISDN service.

Calling Line Identification
Restriction (CLIR) *

Used to switch between the CLIP and CLIR service.

Connected Line
Identification Restriction
(COLR) *

Used to switch between the COLP and COLR service.

ISDN Hold

Used to transfer a call using the telephone company.

Headset

Used to turn on/off the headset mode while idle.
Used to switch between hands-free mode and headset
modes during a conversation.

Time Service Switching
Mode (Automatic/Manual) *

Used to switch between the Automatic Switching and Manual
Switching mode.

Two-way Record

Used to record a conversation into your own mailbox.

Two-way Transfer

Used to record a conversation into the mailbox of a specified
extension.

One-touch Two-way
Transfer

Used to record a conversation into the mailbox of a specified
extension with one-touch.

Live Call Screening (LCS)

Used to monitor your own voice mailbox while an incoming
caller is leaving a message and, if desired, intercept the call.

Voice Mail (VM) Transfer

Used to transfer a call to the mailbox of a specified extension.

*: One-touch Feature Setting Buttons: Pressing these buttons while on-hook changes the
feature settings. The new mode will be displayed for a preprogrammed time period.

Conditions
•

The Flexible DSS button lights of the KX-T7040 and KX-T7240 shows only "Off" or "Red
On". If the button is customised as a button which shows other light patterns, the other light
patterns also show only as "Red On".
Feature Guide

175

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.3 Customising the Buttons

176

Feature Guide

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

1.19.3 LED Indication
Description
The light (LED: Light Emitting Diode) of the Message/Ringer Lamp and following buttons (Line
Status Buttons and Corresponding Extension Status Button) show line conditions with a variety
of light patterns.
Line Status Buttons: S-CO, G-CO, L-CO, INTERCOM, ICD Group
Corresponding Extension Status Button: DSS

1. Light Pattern of the Message/Ringer Lamp
[DPT]
•
•
•
•
[APT]
•
•
•

Incoming call from a trunk: Red flashing
Incoming call from another extension: Green flashing
Message(s) present (no incoming call): Red on
No message(s) present (no incoming call): Off
Incoming call: Red flashing
Message(s) present (no incoming call): Red on
No message(s) present (no incoming call): Off

Feature Guide

177

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

2. Light Pattern of the Line Status Buttons
Line Status
Button:

Intercom
Line Status

Trunk Status

Light
Pattern

S-CO

G-CO

Off
Green on

L-CO
Idle

INTERCOM

This extension is holding the line.

Moderate
green
flashing

This extension is holding the line using Exclusive Hold
or using the line for an Unattended Conference.

Rapid green
flashing

Red on

Slow red
flashing
Rapid red
flashing

Incoming
Incoming call
call/Privacy
Release
–
Incoming
–
Other
call for
extensions
another
are using
extension/
all trunks
Another
in the trunk
extension
group.
is using the
line/Another
extension
has the line
on Exclusive
Hold.
–
–
–
Another
extension
is holding
the line.
Incoming call to the incoming call
–
distribution group in Ring
distribution method

3. Light Pattern of the Corresponding Extension Status Button
Corresponding
Extension
Status Button

DSS

Light Pattern

Feature Guide

ICD Group

This extension is using the line.

Slow green
flashing

178

Incoming Call
Distribution
Group Line
Status

Off

Idle

Red on

Busy/Incoming call*1/DND for trunk calls

Rapid red flashing

Incoming call*2

*1:

Only when Call Pickup by a DSS button is disabled.

*2:

Only when Call Pickup by a DSS button is enabled.

This extension
is logged out
of the incoming
call distribution
group.

–

–

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

4. Flashing Light Patterns
1s
Slow Flashing

Moderate Flashing

Rapid Flashing

Conditions
•
•

The incoming call shows on the buttons in the following priority:
ICD Group S-CO G-CO L-CO INTERCOM
The light pattern of a DSS button for incoming call can be set to "Off" through system
programming. In this case, the DSS button light will not indicate the status of the
corresponding extension.

Feature Guide References
1.2.2.2 Group Call Distribution
1.2.2.6 Log-in/Log-out
1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)
1.12.1 Call Hold
1.13.1.2 Conference
1.13.1.3 Privacy Release

Feature Guide

179

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

1.19.4 Display Information
Description
A display PT shows the user the following information while making or receiving calls if they
are available:
Display Item

Display Example

Condition

The extension number and name of the
123: Tom Smith
calling or called extension, or incoming call
distribution group

–

Status of the called extension

123: Busy

–

The number and name of the optional
device

Door 02: 1st Door

–

The dialled telephone number

1234567890

–

ABC Company
12345678
Line 001: Sales
102:Mike

The first line message
can be either (a), (c),
or (e) at each
extension through
system programming.

The received call information
a) Caller’s name
b) Caller’s number
c) Trunk number/name
d) Original Destination, if the call is
forwarded
e) DDI/DID/MSN name or number

Panasonic

Call charge fee during a trunk call.

12.35

The currency (
Currency [131]),
position of the
currency symbol, and
the decimal point (
Decimal Point
Position for Currency
[130]) are
programmable.

Call duration during a trunk call.

Line 001 11:02’28

–

Conditions
•

•

•

•

180

Feature Guide

Multilingual Display
Each extension can select its display language through personal programming (Display
Language Selection).
Display Contrast
It is possible to adjust the display contrast through personal programming (Display
Contrast Selection). This is available only for DPTs.
Display Backlight
Each extension can select its display backlight on or off through personal programming
(Display Backlight Selection). This is available for the KX-T7633 and KX-T7636.
Characters (name) or digits (number) exceeding the display’s size limitation are not
displayed. In this case, information which have been programmed is hidden, but not
altered.

1.19 Proprietary Telephone (PT) Features

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode

Feature Guide

181

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)
Service Features
1.20.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)
1.20.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—SUMMARY
Description
ISDN is a digital switching and transmission network. ISDN transmits voice, data, and image
in digital format. ISDN lines, if available, can be connected to public line (trunk), private line
(QSIG), or ISDN terminal devices (extension).

1. ISDN Interface and Configuration
Interface Type

Description

Port Mode

Basic Rate
Provides two 64 kbps B channels Trunk,
Extension
Interface (BRI) for communication and one 16
kbps D channel for signalling (2B
+ D).
QSIG (Master,
Slave)

Configuration
Type*
Point-to-Point/
Point-tomultipoint
Point-to-Point

Point-to-Point
Primary Rate Provides thirty or twenty-three 64 Trunk, QSIG
(Master, Slave),
Interface (PRI) kbps B channels for
communication and one 64 kbps Extension
D channel for signalling (30B + D/
23B + D).
*:

BRI Configuration [426] *For BRI only

Note
Point-to-Point (P-P):
One ISDN terminal device can be connected to one ISDN port.
Point-to-multipoint (P-MP):
A maximum of eight ISDN terminal devices can be connected to one ISDN port.

182

Feature Guide

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

2. ISDN Supplementary Service Table for Public Network
Service

Description

Details in

Direct Dialling In
(DDI)

Directs a call with a DDI number to a
preprogrammed destination. (P-P only)

• 1.1.1.3 Direct
Inward Dialling
(DID)/Direct
Dialling In
(DDI)

Multiple
Subscriber
Number (MSN)

One ISDN port can support a maximum of 10
MSNs for routing incoming calls. (P-MP only)

• 1.1.1.4
Multiple
Subscriber
Number
(MSN) Ringing
Service

Calling Line
Identification
Presentation
(CLIP)

Sends the caller’s telephone number to the
network when making a call. The called party
can see the number on his telephone display
before answering the call.

Connected Line
Identification
Presentation
(COLP)

• 1.20.1.2
Calling/
Connected
Line
Identification
Sends the telephone number of the answered
Presentation
party to the network when answering a call. The
(CLIP/COLP)
caller can see the number on his telephone
display when the line is connected.

Calling Line
Prevents the caller’s CLI being presented to the
Identification
called party by the caller.
Restriction (CLIR)
Connected Line
Identification
Restriction
(COLR)

Prevents COLP being sent by the answered
party.

Subaddressing
(SUB)

You may add digits after the telephone number. –
These digits will be passed to ISDN terminal
device.

User-to-user
Signalling Type 1
(UUS-1)

Transmits a specified volume of the data through –
the D channel between the ISDN terminal
devices of different PBXs using UUS types 1.

Advice of Charge
(AOC)

The PBX can receive the call charge information • 1.20.1.3
on ISDN lines from the telephone company.
Advice of
Charge (AOC)

Call Forwarding
(CF)—by ISDN

Forwards an incoming call to another outside
party using the ISDN service of the telephone
company.

• 1.20.1.4 Call
Forwarding
(CF)—by
ISDN (P-MP)
• 1.20.1.5 Call
Forwarding
(CF)—by
ISDN (P-P)

Feature Guide

183

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

Service

Description

Details in

Call Hold
(HOLD)—by ISDN

Puts one ISDN call on hold.

• 1.20.1.6 Call
Hold
(HOLD)—by
ISDN

Call Transfer
(CT)—by ISDN

Transfers an ISDN call to an outside party. Call
Transfer with Announcement and Call Transfer
without Announcement are available.

• 1.20.1.7 Call
Transfer
(CT)—by
ISDN

Three-party
Conference
(3PTY)—by ISDN

Establishes a three-party conference call using
the ISDN service of the telephone company.

• 1.20.1.8
Three-party
Conference
(3PTY)—by
ISDN

Malicious Call
Identification
(MCID)

An extension user can ask the telephone
• 1.20.1.9
company to trace a malicious caller. Information Malicious Call
on the malicious call will be received later on.
Identification
(MCID)

Completion of
Calls to Busy
Subscriber
(CCBS)

If an outside called party is busy, an extension
can receive callback ringing when the called
party becomes free.

• 1.20.1.10
Completion of
Calls to Busy
Subscriber
(CCBS)

3. ISDN Centrex Service
An extension user can have access to the features of the ISDN Centrex Service of the
telephone company (e.g., Call Transfer). This is used by putting the current ISDN call on
hold by sending a flash/recall signal. This feature is enabled or disabled for each ISDN
port.

4. Private Networking Connection (QSIG)
Private networking with QSIG is possible using an ISDN line. The QSIG mode, Master or
Slave, can be enabled on an ISDN port basis.

5. ISDN Extension (

1.20.1.11 ISDN Extension)

An ISDN (BRI/PRI) port can be used for extension connection. While the extension
connection is enabled, ISDN terminal devices (e.g., ISDN telephone, G4 fax machine,
personal computer) or a behind PBX can be connected to the port.
When the ISDN port is in P-P configuration, one ISDN terminal device can be connected
to the port. When the ISDN port is in P-MP configuration, a maximum of eight ISDN
terminal devices can be connected to the port. However, only a maximum of two devices
can be used simultaneously.

Conditions
•

184

Feature Guide

Overlap/En bloc
ISDN call dialling mode, Overlap or En bloc, can be selected for each ISDN port. When
"Overlap" is selected, the PBX sends each dialled digit individually. When "En bloc" is
selected, the PBX sends all of dialled digits at once after the extension user completes
dialling. The PBX recognises end of dialling as follows:

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

– Dialling #, if programmed
– Dialling a preprogrammed telephone number
– Inter-digit timer expires.
•
•
•

•

•

•
•

Some supplementary services are provided by the key protocol ( 1.20.1.12 ISDN
Service Access by Keypad Protocol).
Extension Number
An extension number can be assigned to each ISDN port.
Network Type
Each ISDN port can be set to the requirements of each country/area ( BRI Network
Type [420] *For BRI only).
L1 Active Mode and L2 Data Link Mode
The active mode of Layer 1 (L1) ( BRI Layer 1 Active Mode [424] *For BRI only) and the
data link mode of Layer 2 (L2) ( BRI Layer 2 Active Mode [425] *For BRI only) can be
selected individually, Permanent or Call by Call, on an ISDN port basis.
TEI Assignment Mode
The Terminal Endpoint Identifier (TEI) assignment mode can be selected on an ISDN port
basis ( BRI TEI Mode [427] *For BRI only).
Bearer Mode
The bearer mode can be assigned on an extension basis.
Automatic ISDN Configuration
ISDN (BRI) port configuration can be set automatically through system programming.
The following items will be set by making and receiving a call using the subscriber number
assigned for each ISDN (BRI) port:
–
–
–
–

L1 Active Mode
L2 Data Link Mode
Access Mode (Point-to-Point/Point-to-Multipoint)
TEI Assignment Mode (Fix 00–63/Automatic)

Feature Guide References
1.28.3 QSIG Network

Feature Guide

185

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation
(CLIP/COLP)
Description
Calling Line Identification Presentation (CLIP):
The PBX can send a preprogrammed telephone number to the network when an extension
user makes a call. The called party can see the number on his telephone display before
answering the call.
Connected Line Identification Presentation (COLP):
The PBX sends a preprogrammed telephone number to the network when the extension user
answers an incoming call. The caller can see the number of the answering party on his
telephone display when the call is answered.
These features comply with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications:
ETS 300 092 Calling Line Identification Presentation (CLIP) supplementary service.
ETS 300 097 Connected Line Identification Presentation (COLP) supplementary service.
[CLIP Example]
1) Dials
"87654321".

2) "12345678"
is displayed.
PBX

ISDN
Caller
(CLIP/COLP No.: 12345678)

Called party
(CLIP/COLP No.: 87654321)

[COLP Example]
1) Dials
"111222333".
PBX

ISDN
Caller
3) "111222444"
is displayed.

Called party
(CLIP/COLP No.:
111222333)

FWD, IRNA, etc.
Answering party
(CLIP/COLP No.:
111222444)
2) Answers the call.

186

Feature Guide

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

CLIP/COLP Number:
The telephone numbers sent to the network for CLIP/COLP can be assigned as follows:
•
CLIP/COLP number for each ISDN port (subscriber’s number) ( BRI Subscriber
Number [422] *For BRI only)
•
CLIP/COLP number for each extension ( CLIP/COLP Number [606])
•
CLIP/COLP number for each incoming call distribution group
Each extension can select either the CLIP/COLP number for the ISDN port or the extension to
be used. The CLIP/COLP number for the incoming call distribution group is used when making
a call by pressing the ICD Group button or receiving a call which arrives at the ICD Group
button.
Calling/Connected Line Identification Restriction (CLIR/COLR):
It is possible for each extension to restrict the sending of its telephone number to the network
by pressing the CLIR button, COLR button, or entering the feature number.
These features comply with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications:
ETS 300 093 Calling Line Identification Restriction (CLIR) supplementary service.
ETS 300 098 Connected Line Identification Restriction (COLR) supplementary service.

Conditions
•
•
•
•

•
•

The availability of this feature is dependent on the contract with the telephone company.
The CLIP/COLP number for the connected ISDN port can be used for the ISDN terminal
devices which cannot be assigned their own CLIP/COLP number, such as a doorphone.
COLP/CLIR/COLR Assignment for Each Port
Each service can be enabled or disabled on each ISDN port of the PBX.
CLIR Button and COLR Button
It is possible to switch between CLIP and CLIR by pressing the CLIR button, and COLP
and COLR by pressing the COLR button. A flexible button can be customised as the CLIR
or COLR button.
The CLIP/COLP number must match the telephone number provided by the telephone
company. Otherwise it will be ignored or replaced by another number.
When using a private network, the extension number assigned for each extension through
system programming ( Extension Number [003]) is sent for CLIP/COLP. ( 1.28.3.2
Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected
Name Identification Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG)

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.4 Displaying Your Telephone Number on the Called Party and Caller’s Telephone
(Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation [CLIP/COLP])
1.7.5 Preventing Your Telephone Number Being Displayed on the Caller’s Telephone
(Connected Line Identification Restriction [COLR])
1.7.6 Preventing Your Number Being Displayed on the Called Party’s Telephone (Calling
Line Identification Restriction [CLIR])
Feature Guide

187

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.3 Advice of Charge (AOC)
Description
The PBX can receive the call charge information on ISDN lines from the telephone company.
There are the following types:
Type

Description

Advice of Charge During Call
(AOC-D)

AOC is received during the call and when the call is
completed.

Advice of Charge
At End of Call (AOC-E)

AOC is received when the call is completed.

This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 182 Advice of Charge (AOC) supplementary service Digital
Subscriber Signalling System No. One (DSS1) protocol.

Conditions
•
•

•

188

Feature Guide

A DPT user can see the call charge information on the display during the call.
Budget Management
If the amount of call charge reaches the preprogrammed limit, an extension user cannot
make further calls. ( 1.8.2 Budget Management)
AOC for ISDN extension
An ISDN extension also receives AOC.

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.4 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-MP)
Description
An extension user can forward the incoming ISDN call to another outside party using the ISDN
service of the telephone company, instead of the PBX feature, when the call is received through
an ISDN line.
Extension users can set the forward destination to the network on an MSN basis. The setting
must have been done beforehand to use this feature. There are the following types:
Type

Description

Call Forwarding—
Incoming calls are forwarded unconditionally.
Unconditional (CFU)
Call Forwarding—
Busy (CFB)

An incoming call is forwarded when the
destination on the PBX is busy.

Call Forwarding—No An incoming call is forwarded when the
Reply (CFNR)
destination on the PBX does not answer within a
preprogrammed time period.
When the CFB or CFNR has been set, the network determines to forward the incoming call to
the preprogrammed destination after the call reached the PBX once. When the CFU has been
set, the network forwards the call directly to the preprogrammed destination.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 207 Diversion supplementary service.
[Example]





ISDN
MSN:123-4567
CFU
Destination: 01-23-4567

ISDN

MSN: 123-4567
987-6543

PBX

Outside Caller

PBX

Outside Party
(01-23-4567)

Dials "123-4567".

Extn. 1011
(MSN: 123-4567
Forward Destination
of Trunk Calls: 01-23-4567)

Outside Caller

Outside Party
(01-23-4567)

Dials "123-4567".

Extn. 1011

Feature Guide

189

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

Conditions
•
•
•

The availability of this feature is dependent on the contract with the telephone company.
The feature requires the MSN service. ( 1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN)
Ringing Service)
COS programming determines the extensions that are able to use this feature.

Feature Guide References
1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.5.1 Forwarding Calls

190

Feature Guide

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.5 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-P)
Description
An extension user can forward the incoming ISDN call to another outside party using the ISDN
service of the telephone company, instead of the PBX feature, when the call is received through
an ISDN line.
The network directly forwards the call to the destination which the extension user has set on
the PBX as the forward destination of trunk calls; the network is instructed by the PBX. This
feature is available only when the call is received through an ISDN port which supports this
feature.
Call Forwarding—Unconditional (CFU), Call Forwarding—Busy (CFB), and Call Forwarding—
No Reply (CFNR) are applied to this feature.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 207 Diversion supplementary service.
[Example]





ISDN

CF Request
to 01-23-4567

PBX
PBX

Outside Caller

Outside Party
(01-23-4567)

Dials "01-45-6789".

Extn. 1011
(DDI No.: 01-45-6789
Forward Destination
of Trunk Calls: 01-23-4567)

Outside Caller

Outside Party
(01-23-4567)

Dials "01-45-6789".

Extn. 1011
(DDI No.: 01-45-6789
Forward Destination
of Trunk Calls: 01-23-4567)

Conditions
•
•
•

The availability of this feature is dependent on the contract with the telephone company.
This feature can be enabled or disabled on each ISDN port of the PBX.
This feature is available when the same trunk group is used for the incoming call and the
forwarded call.

Feature Guide References
1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)

Feature Guide

191

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

User Manual References
User Manual
1.5.1 Forwarding Calls

192

Feature Guide

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.6 Call Hold (HOLD)—by ISDN
Description
An ISDN call can be put on hold using the ISDN service of the telephone company, instead of
the PBX feature. This can be a part of a Call Transfer (CT)—by ISDN ( 1.20.1.7 Call Transfer
(CT)—by ISDN) and Three-party Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN ( 1.20.1.8 Three-party
Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN). This feature allows an ISDN call to be held, and a call to be
made to another outside party using only one communication channel of ISDN. A PT user can
easily use this feature by pressing the ISDN Hold button.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 141 Call Hold (HOLD) supplementary service.

Conditions
•
•
•
•
•

ISDN Hold Button
A flexible button can be customised as the ISDN Hold button.
The availability of this feature is dependent on the contract with the telephone company.
The TRS/Barring feature is applied when making a call after activating this feature. (
1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring))
ARS cannot be applied to the call dialled after activating this feature. ( 1.9.1 Automatic
Route Selection (ARS))
It is impossible to seize any other trunk during this feature.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

Feature Guide

193

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.7 Call Transfer (CT)—by ISDN
Description
An ISDN call can be transferred to an outside party using the ISDN service of the telephone
company, instead of the PBX feature, without occupying a second ISDN line.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 369 Explicit Call Transfer (ECT) supplementary service.

Conditions
•
•
•
•
•

The availability of this feature is dependent on the contract with the telephone company.
This feature can be enabled or disabled on an ISDN port basis.
If an ISDN port is in P-P configuration, this feature can be used only when the network
supports the "explicit linkage" option.
Call Transfer with Announcement and Call Transfer without Announcement is possible. (
1.11.1 Call Transfer)
The call charges after completing this feature will not be recorded by the PBX.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.1 Transferring a Call (Call Transfer)

194

Feature Guide

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.8 Three-party Conference (3PTY)—by ISDN
Description
During a conversation using an ISDN line, an extension user can add another party and
establish a three-party conference call using the ISDN service of the telephone company,
instead of the PBX feature.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 188 Three-Party (3PTY) supplementary service.

Conditions
•
•

The availability of this feature is depending on the contract with the telephone company.
This feature can be enabled or disabled on an ISDN port basis.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.5 Multiple Party Conversation

Feature Guide

195

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.9 Malicious Call Identification (MCID)
Description
An extension user can ask the telephone company to trace a malicious caller during a call or
while hearing reorder tone after the caller hangs up. Information on the malicious call will be
received later on.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 130 Malicious Call Identification (MCID) supplementary service.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.3.6 Identifying Malicious Calling Parties (Malicious Call Identification [MCID])

196

Feature Guide

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)
Description
If the called party is busy and the call has been made using an ISDN line, an extension user
can set to receive callback ringing when the called party becomes free. When the user answers
the callback ringing, that party’s number is automatically dialled.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 359 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS) supplementary
service.

Conditions
•

This feature is available under the following conditions:

a) The caller’s PBX is capable of using CCBS and the service is provided by the network.
b) The called party’s PBX is capable of accepting CCBS.
•
•
•
•

•
•

To receive and send CCBS, receiving and sending CCBS must be enabled individually on
an ISDN port basis through system programming.
An extension user can set only one CCBS. The last setting is effective.
The CCBS setting is cancelled if there is no callback ringing within 60 minutes or callback
ringing is not answered within 10 seconds.
If an extension user makes a call using the CCBS feature, the preassigned CLIP number
for the extension will be used even though the extension has set CLIR or the extension has
used the CLIP for the incoming call distribution group by pressing the ICD Group button
when the CCBS has set. ( 1.20.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation
(CLIP/COLP))
After using the CCBS feature, using Last Number Redial will not retrieve the number
dialled by CCBS. ( 1.6.1.4 Last Number Redial)
An extension user that has set the CCBS feature cannot receive callback ringing while the
extension is holding a call.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer

Feature Guide

197

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.11 ISDN Extension
Description
An ISDN (BRI/PRI) port can be used for either trunk or extension connection. When extension
connection is enabled, ISDN terminal devices (e.g., ISDN telephone, G4 fax machine, personal
computer) or a behind PBX can be connected to the port.
If the ISDN port is in point-to-point (P-P) configuration, one terminal device can be connected
to the port. If the ISDN port is in point-to-multipoint (P-MP) configuration, a maximum of eight
terminal devices can be connected to the port. However, only a maximum of two devices can
be used simultaneously.
Individual terminal devices on a behind PBX can be addressed with Multiple Subscriber
Number (MSN). The MSN consists of the ISDN extension number and an additional digit, 0
through 9 or 00 through 99.
[Example]

ISDN Port for
EXTN. (P-MP)

Extn. No.: 1234
1234:
Up to eight terminals
can be connected to
the port and receive
a call simultaneously.

...
PBX

(1234)
ISDN Port for
EXTN. (P-MP)

(1234)

...

(1234)

Extn. No.: 13X (MSN)

131–139:
Up to eight terminals
can be connected to
the port.
...

(131)

(132)

...

130:
All terminals receive
a call simultaneously.

(139)

Extn. No.: 14XX (MSN)
ISDN Port for
EXTN. (P-P/P-MP)
ISDN Port for
EXTN. (P-P/P-MP)

Behind
PBX
Extn. No.: 15XX
(MSN)

...
(1400)

Idle Extension
Hunting is available.

(1401) ... (1499)

1400–1499:
Each terminal
receives a call.
(Use the DDI/MSN
feature of the
behind PBX.)

Conditions
•

•

198

Feature Guide

Subaddressing
Subaddressing is possible between ISDN terminal devices. The subaddress goes through
the PBX to the ISDN terminal devices directly.
Call Transfer (PBX feature) is available only for ISDN extensions in P-MP configuration.
( 1.11.1 Call Transfer)

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

•

•

ISDN extensions can belong to an incoming call distribution group ( 1.2.2 Incoming Call
Distribution Group Features) or idle extension hunting group ( 1.2.1 Idle Extension
Hunting). In this case, an MSN can be assigned.
If the last digit of the MSN is "0", all terminal devices on the same ISDN port receive the
call simultaneously, if the specification of each terminal device is available. To use the
MSN whose last digit is "0" as an individual MSN, system programming is required for
each ISDN port.

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service

Feature Guide

199

1.20 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) Service Features

1.20.1.12 ISDN Service Access by Keypad Protocol
Description
ISDN provides some supplementary services by key protocol, and they may require a service
access code to be dialled.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 122 Generic keypad protocol for the support of supplementary service
(ISDN Service Access).

Conditions
•

•

ISDN Service Button
A flexible button can be customised as an ISDN Service button. A service access code
can also be assigned on this button for a quick operation.
This feature is not available to an SLT.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.5 Accessing the ISDN Service (ISDN Service Access)

200

Feature Guide

1.21 E1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

1.21 E1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KXTDA200 only)
1.21.1 E1 Line Service (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)
Description
The E1 line carries thirty 64 kbps-voice channels at 2.048 Mbps transmission speed as a trunk
or private line. Voice is digitised by Pulse Code Modulation (PCM).

1. Channel Type
[DR2 (Digital System R2)/E & M-C (Continuous E & M)/E & M-P (Pulsed E & M)]
The E1 card supports three different channel types to provide connection at minimum
expense. One of the three channel types can be assigned to one of the 30 channels of the
E1 card individually according to tariffs and customer needs.

2. E1 Features
The following table shows the features available for each channel type:
[Feature Table]
Channel Type (1) TIE

(2) DID

(3) DIL

(4) ANI

DR2

*1

E & M-C

*2

E & M-P

*2

(5) Call Charge
Information

: Available
Receiving Dial Mode should be MFC-R2.
*2: Available when this PBX is connected to the KX-TDA100, KX-TDA200, or KXTD500.
*1:

Feature Guide

201

1.21 E1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

[Explanation]
Number in
the table

Feature

Description

(1)

TIE Line Service Refer to the TIE Line Service feature. (
Service)

1.28.1 TIE Line

(2)

Direct Inward
Dialling (DID)

Refer to the DID feature. ( 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling
(DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI))

(3)

Direct In Line
(DIL)

Refer to the DIL feature. (

(4)

Automatic
Number
Identification
(ANI)

Outgoing ANI:
Sends the caller’s number to the E1 line. The sending
method is the same as ISDN CLIP service. ( 1.20.1.2
Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/
COLP))
Incoming ANI:
Receives the caller’s number from the E1 line.
When the ANI number is received, it can be treated the
same as a Caller ID number. ( 1.17.1 Caller ID)

(5)

Call Charge
Information

The call charge meter pulses can be received during a
conversation. ( 1.25.2 Charge Meter)

1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL))

Conditions
•
•

202

Feature Guide

If an E1 line is used as a trunk, the channel type depends on the contract with the
telephone company.
If "MFC-R2" is selected as the Dial Mode, the PBX always sends a dial tone, instead of the
telephone company, when making a trunk call using E1 line.

1.22 T1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

1.22 T1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KXTDA200 only)
1.22.1 T1 Line Service (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)
Description
The T1 line carries twenty-four 64 kbps-voice channels at 1.5 Mbps transmission speed as a
trunk or private line. Voice is digitised by Pulse Code Modulation (PCM).

1. Channel Type
[LCOT/GCOT/DID/TIE/OPX]
The T1 card supports five different channel types to provide connection at minimum
expense. One of the five channel types can be assigned to one of the 24 channels of the
T1 card individually according to tariffs and customer needs.

2. T1 Features
The following table shows the features available for each channel type:
[Feature Table]
Channel Type (1) TIE

(2) DID

(3) DIL

(4) OPX (5) ANI

LCOT
GCOT
DID
TIE (E & M)
OPX
: Available
[Explanation]
Number in
the Table

Feature

Description

(1)

TIE Line
Service

Refer to the TIE Line Service feature. (
Service)

1.28.1 TIE Line

(2)

Direct Inward Refer to the DID feature. ( 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward
Dialling (DID) Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI))

(3)

Direct In Line Refer to the DIL feature. (
(DIL)

1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL))

Feature Guide

203

1.22 T1 Line Service Features (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

Number in
the Table
(4)

Feature
Off Premise
Extension
(OPX)

Description
An SLT which is installed off site can perform as if it were
installed locally. The SLT makes and receives a call
through the PBX. An extension number can be given to
the OPX, and extension data such as COS is also
applied.
[Example]
Telephone Company
SLT
T1 LCOT T1 OPX
T1 Card

Extn.103

PBX

Dials "103".
Extn.101

(5)

Extn.102

Receives the caller’s number from the T1 line.
Automatic
Number
When the ANI number is received, it can be treated the
Identification same as a Caller ID number. ( 1.17.1 Caller ID)
(ANI)

Conditions
•

204

Feature Guide

If a T1 line is used as a trunk, the channel type depends on the contract with the telephone
company.

1.23 Voice Mail Features

1.23 Voice Mail Features
1.23.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group
Description
A VPS can be connected to extension ports on the PBX. The extension ports make a group,
called a VM group. This group has a floating extension number. The VM group can be the
destination for redirected calls and incoming calls. When receiving a call, the VPS can greet
the caller offering them the option to leave a message or dial a number to reach the desired
party. The VPS can record the message for each extension and leave notification on the
corresponding extension, if the called extension is not able to answer calls.

1. VM Group Type
Type

Description

VM (DTMF) Group

A group of SLT ports which use the Voice Mail DTMF Integration
features. A maximum of two VM (DTMF) groups can be
assigned.

VM (DPT) Group

A group of DPT ports which use the Voice Mail DPT (Digital)
Integration features.
With the KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200:
•
A maximum of two VM (DPT) groups can be assigned.
•
One Panasonic KX-TVS/KX-TVP system can be in
only one group.
•
A maximum of 12 ports (24 channels) of the VPS can
form each group.
With the KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30:
•
One VM (DPT) group can be assigned.
•
A maximum of 4 ports (8 channels) of the VPS can
form a group.

[Example]
PBX

DPT
Port

SLT
Port

VM (DPT) Group
Floating extn. no. 100

VM (DTMF) Group
Floating extn. no. 250

Extn.101 Extn.102 Extn.103 Extn.104

Extn.117 Extn.118 Extn.119 Extn.120

DPT
Port

DPT
Port

DPT
Port

DPT
Port

VPS
(DPT [Digital] Integration)

SLT
Port

SLT
Port

SLT
Port

SLT
Port

VPS
(DTMF Integration)

Feature Guide

205

1.23 Voice Mail Features

VM (DTMF) Group Assignment:
The VPS is connected to the SLT ports of the PBX. These SLT ports, as well as VM
(DTMF) Group settings, must be configured to allow DTMF Integration, as shown in the
following [Programming Example of Extension Port] and [Programming Example of VM
(DTMF) Group].
VM (DPT) Group Assignment:
The VPS is connected to the DPT ports of the PBX. These DPT ports, as well as VM (DPT)
group settings, must be configured to allow DPT (Digital) Integration, as shown in the
following [Programming Example of Extension Port] and [Programming Example of VM
(DPT) Group].
[Programming Example of Extension Port]
DPT Property
Slot

3
3
:
4
4
:
5
5
:
6
6
*:

Port Port Type Extn. No.

1
2
:
1
2
:
1
2
:
1
2

DPT
DPT
:
S-Hybrid
S-Hybrid
:
SLT
SLT
:
SLT
SLT

101
102
:
201
202
:
301
302
:
401
402

VM (DPT)
VM (DPT)
:
VM (DPT)
VM (DPT)
:

Unit No.
of VPS
1
1
:
2
2
:

Port No.
of VPS
1
2
:
1
2
:

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

Type*

:

:

:

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

Not assignable

VM (DPT)
Group 1
VM (DPT)
Group 2
VM (DTMF)
Group 1
VM (DTMF)
Group 2

Terminal Device Assignment [601]

[Programming Example of VM (DTMF) Group]

VM (DTMF)
Group No.

Floating
Extension
No.

Group
Name

Service
Mode

1
2

300
400

Company C
Company D

AA
VM

Extension No. of
Port Connected to
VPS Port
1
2
…
301
302
…
401
402
…

[Programming Example of VM (DPT) Group]

VM (DPT) Group No.
1
2
*:

Floating Extension No.*
100
200

Group Name
Company A
Company B

VM Group Floating Extension Number [660]

2. Incoming Calls to VM Group
When incoming calls are received at the floating extension number of the VM group, calls
will hunt starting at the lowest VM port number. In this case, the FWD and DND settings
( 1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND)) for each extension port are
disregarded.
It is programmable whether the calls queue when all extension ports in the group are busy
through system programming. If the queuing is disabled through system programming, the
206

Feature Guide

1.23 Voice Mail Features

call will be redirected to the destination, assigned on the trunk group which receives the
call, by the Intercept Routing feature.

Conditions
[General]
•

•

It is possible to call an extension (extension port) in a VM group directly. If the calls are
routed directly to the extension in the group, it is possible to enable some features (e.g.,
FWD, Idle Extension Hunting) on the extension in the group.
The Voice Mail DTMF/DPT (Digital) Integration (e.g., command transmit) is also available
on the extension.
One-touch Voice Mail Feature Access
It is possible to assign a One-touch Dialling button for direct access to a Voice Mail feature.
( 1.6.1.2 One-touch Dialling) For example, to access a mailbox (mailbox number 123)
of the VPS (extension number 165) directly, assign "165#6123" to a One-touch Dialling
button. When pressing this button, the outgoing message (OGM) of the mailbox will be
heard.

[KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200]
•

All ports in a VM (DPT) group must be connected to a single DHLC or DLC card.

[KX-TDA15/KX-TDA30]
•

All ports in a VM (DPT) group must be connected to either the same DLC card, or to the
preinstalled Super Hybrid ports.

Feature Guide References
1.23.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration
1.23.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration

Feature Guide

207

1.23 Voice Mail Features

1.23.2 Voice Mail DTMF Integration
Description
The PBX and the VPS connected to the PBX can transmit commands using DTMF signals to
each other. The PBX sends preprogrammed commands using DTMF to the VPS automatically
to change the answering service between Voice Mail (VM) service mode and Automated
Attendant (AA) service mode or to inform the extension status (e.g., busy). The VPS sends the
commands to the PBX like an SLT.
The following answering services and features are available:

1. Voice Mail (VM) Service Mode
When a caller reaches the VPS, the VPS greets and guides the caller to leave a voice
message for a specified mailbox.
[Example]
The VPS sends the message to the caller, "Thank you for calling Panasonic. Please enter
the mailbox number of the person you wish to leave your message for."
The caller dials the mailbox number. Then, the dialled number is sent to the VPS via the
PBX.
The VPS sends the personal greeting to the caller, "You have reached Mike's voice mail.
I am sorry I cannot take your call right now. Please leave a message and I will call you
back."
The caller leaves a message.
If the call reroutes to the floating extension number of the VM (DTMF) Group or the
extension in the VM (DTMF) group by such as the FWD feature, when the VPS answers
the call, the PBX will dial the mailbox number of the corresponding group or extension and
any other digits required to the VPS automatically using the caller-dialled number (Follow
on ID). In this case, the caller can reach a mailbox without knowing the mailbox number.
[Available Features for Follow on ID]

a)
b)
c)
d)

FWD to a Mailbox
Intercept Routing to a Mailbox
Call Transfer to a Mailbox
Listening to a Message in a Mailbox

2. Automated Attendant (AA) Service Mode
The VPS greets and guides the caller to the desired extension directly without operator
assistance.

3. VM

AA Service, AA
VM Service
It is possible to switch the service mode assigned on the VPS port, from the VM service
to AA service or vice versa.

System Explanation
1. Service Mode Assignment
Assign the service mode, VM service or AA service, to the VM (DTMF) group to

208

Feature Guide

1.23 Voice Mail Features

correspond with the assignment of the VPS.

2. DTMF Command Assignment
Assign the DTMF command to suit the VPS settings.
Command (Default)
Switching to VM

#6

Switching to AA

#8

Recording message

H

Listening message

H

Note: H = Mailbox Number

3. VM Service
a) FWD to a Mailbox of the VPS
The PBX sends a mailbox number of the corresponding extension to the VPS when
a call is forwarded from an extension to the VPS. Therefore the caller can leave a
message for the called extension without knowing the mailbox number.
[FWD to the VPS Sequence Selection]
If an extension user sets FWD to the VPS, any incoming call will be forwarded to the
VPS.
It is also possible to send the AA command, even in the VM service mode, when calls
are forwarded so that the caller can be directed to an extension rather than a mailbox.
This can be performed by selecting "AA" through system programming.
Transmitted Command
Parameter
In AA Service Mode

In VM Service Mode

Answer by
Mailbox
(Default)

Switching to VM command +
Recording message command
Recording message command (H [H = Mailbox No.])
(#6 + H [H = Mailbox No.])

AA

Switching to AA command (#8) Switching to AA command (#8)

None

(DTMF commands are not sent. Work with default of the VPS.)

b) Intercept Routing to a Mailbox of the VPS
The PBX sends a mailbox number of the corresponding extension to the VPS when
a trunk call is intercepted from an extension to the VPS. Therefore the caller can leave
a message for the called extension without knowing the mailbox number.
[Intercept Routing to the VPS Sequence Selection]
If an extension user sets Intercept Routing to the VPS, the intercepted trunk calls will
be redirected to the VPS.
It is also possible to send the AA command, even in the VM service mode, when calls
are intercepted so that the caller can be directed to an extension rather than a
mailbox. This can be performed by selecting "AA" through system programming.

Feature Guide

209

1.23 Voice Mail Features

Transmitted Command
Parameter
In AA Service Mode

In VM Service Mode

Answer by
Mailbox

Switching to VM command +
Recording message command
Recording message command (H [H = Mailbox No.])
(#6 + H [H = Mailbox No.])

AA

Switching to AA command (#8) Switching to AA command (#8)

None (Default) (DTMF commands are not sent. Work with default of the VPS.)

[Example of a) & b)]
Trunk Call

Sent "#6" + "102".

PBX

mailbox number
Switching to VM command

FWD, Intercept

Transfer

VPS (In AA service mode)
Operator

Extn. 102

VM Port 1

VM Port 2
VM (DTMF)
Group

VM Port X

VM Port 3

c) Transferring to a Mailbox of the VPS
An extension user can transfer a call to a mailbox of the VPS so that the caller can
leave a message in the mailbox of the desired extension. The extension user should
use the Voice Mail (VM) Transfer button, when transferring a call to the mailbox of the
VPS. When the extension user presses this button and enters the desired extension
number, the PBX will transfer the call to the VM group and dial the mailbox number of
the desired extension with the required command (after the VPS answers the call).
Therefore the caller can leave a message without knowing the mailbox number.

210

Feature Guide

1.23 Voice Mail Features

[Performance of Pressing the VM Transfer Button and Entering an Extension
Number]
Transmitted Command
In AA Service Mode
Switching to VM command +
Recording message command
(#6 + H [H = Mailbox No.])

In VM Service Mode
Recording message command
(H [H = Mailbox No.])

[Example]
Trunk Call
Sent "#6" + "103".

PBX

mailbox number
Switching to VM command

Transfer with VM Transfer
button + extension number (103)

Extension
(Operator)

VPS (In AA service mode)
VM Port 1

VM Port 2
VM (DTMF)
Group

VM Port X

VM Port 3

d) Listening to a Recorded Message
If the VPS receives a message, the VPS will set the Message Waiting feature (e.g.,
turning on the Message button light) on the corresponding telephone as notification.
( 1.18.1 Message Waiting) Thereby, the VPS notifies the extension user that there
is a message waiting in his mailbox. When the Message button light turns on,
pressing the button allows the extension user to play back the messages stored in his
mailbox without dialling such as a mailbox number. It is programmable whether the
PBX or the VPS cancels the Message Waiting feature (e.g., turning off the Message
button light). When the PBX is selected, the Message Waiting feature is cancelled
after the extension user has accessed the VPS. When the VPS is selected, the
Message Waiting feature is cancelled after the extension user has listened to
messages stored in his mailbox.

Feature Guide

211

1.23 Voice Mail Features

[Performance of Pressing the MESSAGE Button]
Transmitted Command
In AA Service Mode
Switching to VM command +
Listening message command
(#6 + H [H = Mailbox No.])

In VM Service Mode
Listening message command
( H [H = Mailbox No.])

[Example]
PBX

Pressing the
MESSAGE
button
Extn. 102

Sent "#6" + " ", "102".
Listening message
command, mailbox number
Switching to VM command

VPS (In AA
service mode)
Mailbox for
Extn. 102

4. AA Service
If the VPS transfers the call using the AA service, the PBX will inform the VPS of the status
of the called destination with the preprogrammed DTMF status signal so that the VPS can
confirm the status of the extension without listening to the system tones (e.g., ringback
tone).
Assign the DTMF status signal to suit the VPS settings.
[The DTMF Status Signal and Condition]
Status

212

Feature Guide

Condition

Default Command

RBT (ringback
tone)

The PBX is ringing the corresponding
extension.

1

BT (busy tone)

The called extension is busy.

2

ROT (reorder tone) The dialled number is invalid.

3

DND (DND tone)

The called extension has set DND. (
1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND))

4

Answer

The called extension has answered the
call.

5

FWD VM RBT
The called extension has set FWD to
(FWD to Voice Mail VPS and the PBX is calling another port
of the VPS.
ringback tone)

6

FWD VM BT (FWD The called extension has set FWD to
to Voice Mail busy VPS and all ports of the VPS are busy.
tone)

7

1.23 Voice Mail Features

Status

Condition

Default Command

FWD EXT RBT
(FWD to extension
ringback tone)

The PBX is calling an extension other
than the one dialled. FWD or Idle
Extension Hunting ( 1.2.1 Idle
Extension Hunting) may be assigned by
the called extension.

8

Confirm
The PBX receives confirmation that the
(confirmation tone) feature has been successfully set or
cancelled (e.g., Message Waiting) on the
extension.

9

Disconnect

#9

The caller has hung up.

[Example]
1

1

An incoming call reaches the VPS. The VPS
greets the caller: "Thank you for calling
Panasonic. If you know the extension
number of the person you wish… ".

2

The caller dials the extension number (extn.
102). The VPS will transfer the call to the
extension via the PBX.

3

If the extension is not available, the PBX
sends DTMF status signal of the extension
(busy status) to the VPS.

4

The VPS receives the DTMF status signal
and send the appropriate message to the
caller: "Sorry. The extension is busy. Would
you like to leave a message… ".

PBX
2

Transfer

3

Sent "2".
Busy
Status

Busy

Extn.
102

4

VPS

Conditions
•

•
•
•

•
•

Voice Mail (VM) Transfer Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Voice Mail (VM) Transfer button with the floating
extension number of the VM group as the parameter.
It is possible to assign the time period between when the VPS answers the call and the
PBX sends the Follow on ID to the VPS.
It is possible to assign the time period between when the VPS transfers the call using the
AA service to the PBX and the PBX sends the DTMF status signal to the VPS.
It is possible to select whether the mailbox number is the same as the extension number,
or the mailbox number is programmable for each extension number and incoming call
distribution group (Mailbox Access ID).
The Inter-digit time for the DTMF command and for DTMF status signal is programmable.
Data Line Security is set automatically on the extensions in the VM (DTMF) group to
achieve proper recording. ( 1.10.5 Data Line Security)

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing

Feature Guide

213

1.23 Voice Mail Features

1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)
1.11.1 Call Transfer
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons
1.23.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group

User Manual References
User Manual
1.9.3 If a Voice Processing System is Connected

214

Feature Guide

1.23 Voice Mail Features

1.23.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration
Description
A Panasonic VPS that supports DPT (Digital) Integration (e.g., the KX-TVP200) can be
connected to this PBX in a tightly integrated fashion.
DPT (Digital) Integration features can be used when the VPS is connected through DPT ports
of the PBX.

Feature Explanation
1. Automatic Configuration—Quick Setup
The PBX informs the VPS of its extension numbers and the floating extension numbers of
the incoming call distribution groups so that the VPS can create mailboxes with this data
automatically.

2. FWD to a Mailbox of the VPS
If an extension user sets FWD to the VPS, incoming calls are forwarded to the VPS. (
1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)) The PBX sends a mailbox number of the forwarding
extension to the VPS. Therefore the caller can leave a message in the mailbox of the
extension without knowing the mailbox number.

3. Intercept Routing to a Mailbox of the VPS
If an extension user sets Intercept Routing to the VPS, the intercepted trunk calls will be
redirected to the VPS. ( 1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing) If the "Intercept to Mailbox"
setting is enabled through system programming, the PBX sends the mailbox number of
the intercepted extension to the VPS. Therefore the caller can leave a message in the
mailbox of the extension without knowing the mailbox number.

4. Transferring to a Mailbox of the VPS
An extension user can transfer a call to a mailbox of the VPS so that caller can leave a
message in the mailbox of the desired extension. ( 1.11.1 Call Transfer) The extension
user should use the Voice Mail (VM) Transfer button, when transferring a call to the
mailbox of the VPS. When the extension user presses this button and enters the desired
extension number, the PBX will transfer the call to the VM group and dial the mailbox
number of the desired extension number with the required command (after the VPS
answers the call). Therefore the caller can leave a message without knowing the mailbox
number.

5. Transfer Recall to a Mailbox of the VPS
If a call is transferred to an extension via the Automated Attendant (AA) service of the VPS
and the call is not answered within a preprogrammed Transfer Recall time ( Transfer
Recall Time [201]), the PBX sends the mailbox number of the transfer destination
extension to the VPS. Therefore the caller can leave a message in the mailbox of the
extension without knowing the mailbox number. The "Transfer Recall to Mailbox"
setting should be enabled through system programming to use this feature.

6. Listening to a Recorded Message (Direct Mailbox Access)
If the VPS receives a message, the VPS will set the Message Waiting feature (e.g., turning
on the Message button light) on the corresponding telephone as notification. ( 1.18.1
Message Waiting) Thereby, the VPS notifies the extension user that there is a message
waiting in his mailbox. When the Message button light turns on, pressing the button allows
the extension user to play back the messages stored in his mailbox without dialling such
as a mailbox.
When the extension user dials an extension number of the VM (DPT) extension port or the
floating extension number of the VM (DPT) group from his extension, he can listen to the

Feature Guide

215

1.23 Voice Mail Features

messages stored in his mailbox without dialling his mailbox number (Direct Mailbox
Access). It is possible to disable this feature by COS programming on the VPS.

7. VPS Trunk Service & Automatic Time Mode Notification for Incoming Call*
Multiple tenants can share a single VPS; each tenant does not require a dedicated VPS
port. If the destination of the incoming trunk call is a VM (DPT) group, the PBX sends the
VPS trunk group number and time mode (day/lunch/break/night) of the tenant ( 2.2.4
Time Service) assigned for the call to the VPS. Therefore the VPS can send the assigned
message (company greeting) to the caller. Corresponding VPS trunk group number and
tenant number are determined by the setting of the incoming trunk call as follows:

a) DIL/TIE: the setting of each trunk port (

1.1.1.2 Direct In Line (DIL), 1.28.1 TIE

Line Service)

b) DID/DDI: the setting of each location number for DID/DDI (

1.1.1.3 Direct

Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI))

c) MSN: the setting of each MSN (

1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN)

Ringing Service)
[Example]
For DID Calls:
Each location number can have its VPS trunk group number (message number) and
tenant number.

[DID Programming Example]
DID Destination
VPS Trunk Tenant
Location DID No.
DID Name
Group No.
No.
No.
Day Lunch Break Night
0001

123-4567 105

100

105

100

John White

1

1

0002

123-2468 102

100

102

100

Tom Smith

2

3

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

[VPS Programming—Programming Example of Trunk Group Assignment]
Trunk Group No.

1

2

:

Company Greeting No.

Incoming Call Service

··

Day

1

Custom Service 11

··

Lunch

2

Custom Service 29

··

Break

3

Custom Service 31

··

Night

4

Custom Service 12

··

Day

5

Custom Service 21

··

Lunch

6

Custom Service 15

··

Break

7

Custom Service 42

··

Night

8

Custom Service 30

··

:

:

:

··

Explanation:
A DID call reaches a VM (DPT) group directly or by the Intercept Routing feature.
According to the [DID Programming Example] and [VPS Programming—Programming
Example of Trunk Group Assignment], a caller will hear a corresponding company greeting
of the VPS.
216

Feature Guide

1.23 Voice Mail Features

Time mode (day/lunch/break/night) of the preprogrammed tenant is applied to the DID
destination and company greeting number.

Trunk Call

Trunk Call

123-4567

123-2468
Sends the following information:
· VPS Trunk Group: 1
· Time mode: Day

PBX
Intercept

Sends the following information:
· VPS Trunk Group: 2
· Time mode: Night

Tenant 1

Tenant 3

(Company A)

(Company B)

VPS
(Floating Extn. No.100)
Extn. 105

Extn. 102

8. Caller’s Identification Notification to the VPS
When receiving a trunk call, the PBX sends the caller’s identification number/name to the
VPS.

9. DID Number Notification to the VPS
When receiving a trunk call with a DDI/DID number or an MSN, the PBX sends the DDI/
DID number or MSN to the VPS. The number will be sent to the VPS even if the call
reaches the VPS after redirection by, for example, the Intercept Routing feature.

10. Status Notification to the VPS
After the call is redirected by the VPS, the PBX sends the status of the redirected
extension (e.g., busy) to the VPS.

11. Paging by the VPS
The VPS can perform the Paging feature using the recorded message. (

1.14.1 Paging)

12. Live Call Screening (LCS)
PT and PS users can monitor his own mailbox while a caller is leaving a message and, if
desired, answer the call by pressing the LCS button. When the caller is leaving a message
in the mailbox, monitoring can be carried out in two ways: each PT user can choose which
through personal programming (Live Call Screening Mode Set). PS users cannot choose
the way: only Private mode is available for them.
Hands-free mode: The user can monitor the call automatically through the built-in
speaker.
Private mode: The user will hear an alarm tone. To monitor the call, the user goes offhook with the handset, MONITOR button, or SP-PHONE button. However, PS users
cannot monitor the call with the speakerphone.

Feature Guide

217

1.23 Voice Mail Features

13. Two-way Recording into the VPS
A PT user can record a conversation into his own mailbox or another mailbox, while talking
on the phone.
Use the Two-way Record button to record into his own mailbox. Use the Two-way Transfer
button to record into someone else’s mailbox.
Note
When you record Two-way telephone conversations, you should inform the other
party that the conversation is being recorded.

14. VPS Data Control by the PBX*
The data of date and time is controlled by the PBX.

15. Remote PBX Data Control by the VPS*
The FWD of an extension can be controlled by the VPS.
*: This feature may not be supported depending on the software version of the VPS.

Conditions
[General]
•

Voice Mail (VM) Transfer Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Voice Mail (VM) Transfer button with the floating
extension number of the VM group as the parameter.

[Live Call Screening (LCS)]
•

•
•

•

•

If an SLT is connected in parallel to a PT, and if LCS is activated for the PT in Private mode,
both the PT and SLT can be used to monitor calls while in idle status. The SLT will ring to
indicate a message is being recorded. The call can be monitored with the SLT by going
off-hook. To intercept the call, press Flash/Recall button or flash the hookswitch. (
1.10.9 Parallelled Telephone)
LCS Button
A flexible button can be customised as the LCS button.
Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN)
To prevent unauthorised monitoring, it is recommended the LCS user assign an extension
PIN. This PIN will be required when setting LCS. ( 1.26.1 Extension Personal
Identification Number (PIN)) If the user forgets the PIN, it can be cleared by an extension
assigned as the manager.
Each extension can be programmed to either end recording or continue recording the
conversation after the call is intercepted, through personal programming (LCS Mode Set
[After Answering]).
To use the LCS feature on a PS in Wireless XDP Parallel Mode, LCS can only be turned
on or off from the wired telephone. In Wireless XDP Parallel Mode, setting LCS on/off from
the PS has no effect. ( 1.24.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode)

[Two-way Recording into the VPS]
•

218

Feature Guide

Two-way Record/Two-way Transfer Button
A flexible button can be customised as the Two-way Record or the Two-way Transfer
button. An extension number can be assigned to the Two-way Transfer button so that it can
be used as a one-touch record button for the mailbox of the specified extension. (Onetouch Two-way Transfer Button).

1.23 Voice Mail Features

•

When all of the VPS ports are busy:

a) Pressing the Two-way Record button sends an alarm tone
b) Pressing the Two-way Transfer button followed by an extension number sends an
alarm tone.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons
1.23.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group

User Manual References
User Manual
1.9.3 If a Voice Processing System is Connected
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode
3.2.2 Manager Programming

Feature Guide

219

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features
1.24.1 Portable Station (PS) Connection
Description
This PBX supports the connection of a PS (e.g., KX-TD7590, KX-TD7690). It is possible to use
the PBX features using the PS like a PT.

Conditions
•

•

The PS registration is required through the system programming ( PS Registration
[690]). To avoid unexpected registration to another PBX, the Personal Identification
Number (PIN) for the PBX is necessary to register a PS ( Personal Identification
Number (PIN) for PS Registration [692]). The registration can be cancelled ( PS
Termination [691]).
Handover
Even if a PS user moves during a conversation, the PS will automatically switch between
cells without disconnecting the call (Handover).
Handover is available in any of the following cases:

a) During a conversation with an extension or outside party.
b) While a call is ringing at the PS.
c) While the PS is in idle status.

PBX

CS
Handover:
Calls will not be
disconnected.

CS
Interface

CS

On the contrary, Handover is not available in one of the following cases:

a) When the new (Handover) CS is busy.
b) When there is no CS within range.
c) While the Live Call Screening (LCS) or Two-way Record is activated (

1.23.3 Voice

Mail DPT (Digital) Integration).

d)
e)
f)
g)

•

220

Feature Guide

While the PS user is paging other extensions (
During a doorphone call (

1.14.1 Paging).

1.16.1 Doorphone Call).

While the PS user is dialling digits to make a trunk call.

During a conversation with an extension using PC Console or PC Phone, to which the
conversation is being recorded.
When a caller has dialled the extension number of a PS but the CS is busy, the caller hears
a busy tone.

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.8 Connection of DECT Portable Stations — KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200
2.9 Connection of 2.4 GHz Portable Stations — KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200

6.7 Connection of DECT Portable Stations — KX-TDA30
6.8 Connection of 2.4 GHz Portable Stations — KX-TDA30

Feature Guide

221

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

1.24.2 PS Ring Group
Description
PS ring group is a group of PS extensions which receives incoming calls. Each group has a
floating extension number and name. One PS can belong to multiple groups.
[Programming Example]

PS Ring
Group 01

PS Ring
Group 02

PS Ring
Group 03

··

Floating Extn. No.

301

302

303

··

Group Name

Sales 1

Sales 2

Sales 3

··

Caller’s Name/
Number

Caller’s Name/
Number

··

Incoming Trunk Call Called Party’s Name/
Number
Information Display
PS01

··

PS02

··

PS03

··

PS04

··

PS05

··

PS06

··

PS07

··

:

:

:

:

:

: Constituent

PS Ring Group 1
(Floating Extn. No. 301
Name: Sales 1)

PS01
PS03
PS02

PS Ring Group 2
(Floating Extn. No. 302
Name: Sales 2)

PS04

PS06
PS05

Conditions
•
•

•

222

Feature Guide

PS Ring Group
A maximum of 32 groups can be created.
Available PS
The KX-TD7580, KX-TD7590, KX-TCA155, KX-TCA255, KX-TD7680, and KX-TD7690
can join PS ring groups.
Incoming trunk call information is shown on a PS display when a trunk call arrives at a PS
ring group which the PS joins. The display information can be selected on a PS ring group

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

•

•

basis through system programming: Called Party’s Name/Number or Caller’s Name/
Number.
Calling Multiple PSs Simultaneously
There are two methods to call multiple PSs simultaneously using the floating extension
number assigned to the following groups:
Method

Assignment

Merit

Demerit

Details in

Incoming
Call
Distribution
Group

Assign all desired
PSs to one incoming
call distribution group
( Incoming Call
Distribution Group
Member [620]), and
set the group call
distribution method
for the group to
"Ring".

All PS users in the
group can use the
Log-in/Log-out
feature, Wrap-up
feature, and ICD
Group button for
the group.

The CS may often
be busy as each
PS in the group
uses one channel
when a call
arrives at the
group.

• 1.2.2
Incoming
Call
Distribution
Group
Features

PS Ring
Group

Assign all desired
PSs to one PS ring
group.

Only one channel
is used when a
call arrives at the
group.

–
PS users in the
group cannot use
the Log-in/Logout and Wrap-up
features.

When a PS joins a PS ring group, the following personal settings are disregarded:

a) When the PS ring group is called:
– Delayed Ringing
– Display information when the incoming calls arrive;
The settings (e.g., display priority) are disregarded.
– The setting which is assigned on the PS (e.g., FWD)
– The status of the PS (e.g., busy)

b) Log-in/log-out setting (from the PS ring group/from the incoming call distribution
group which the PS ring group belongs to). ( 1.2.2.6 Log-in/Log-out)
Note
Log-in/log-out setting of the PS ring group from the incoming call distribution group is
also disregarded.
PS Ring Group

Log-out

Log-in

Feature Guide

223

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

PS Ring
Group
Log-out
Incoming Call
Distribution Group
PS Ring Group
Log-in

Log-out

Log-in

•

•

•

224

Feature Guide

When the PS ring group is called using the floating extension number, the group becomes
busy to other callers using the floating extension number. However, the individual group
members may be called directly using their extension number.
If a PS in a PS ring group has set the DND feature for trunk calls, the PS will not ring when
an intercom call or a trunk call arrives at the PS ring group. ( 1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb
(DND))
For calls directed to PS ring groups, the PBX will handle at most two calls simultaneously.
The third call cannot arrive at a PS ring group until one of the first two calls is answered or
a caller hangs up.

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

1.24.3 PS Directory
Description
A PS user can store numbers and/or names in the directory. A stored number is dialled by
selecting a name or number in the directory.
Depending on the PS model, the PS user can use the following directories for easy operation:
Type

Description

PS Dialling Directory

Makes a call by selecting from a private directory of names and
telephone numbers.

System Speed Dialling
Directory

Makes a call by selecting from a common directory of names
( System Speed Dialling Name [002]) and numbers (
System Speed Dialling Number [001]).

PBX Extension Dialling Makes a call by selecting from a common directory of extension
Directory
names ( Extension Name [004]).
Shortcut Directory

Accesses a feature by selecting from a private directory of
feature names and numbers.

Quick Dialling

Makes a call or accesses a feature easily by selecting from a
private directory of names and numbers.

Feature Guide

225

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

1.24.4 PS Feature Buttons
Description
A PS user can use PBX feature using a combination of buttons (button + a specified number,
, or #) and/or display operation. The flexible buttons and the display are customised through
PS programming. The button assignment is the same for PT. ( 1.19.2 Flexible Buttons).
Some special feature buttons (e.g., WAVESEARCH button) may be customised depending on
the PS type.

226

Feature Guide

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

1.24.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode
Description
A PS can be used in parallel with a wired telephone (PT/SLT). In this case, the wired telephone
is the main telephone and the PS is the sub telephone. When Wireless XDP Parallel Mode is
enabled, the two telephones share one extension number (main telephone’s extension
number) like XDP Parallel mode for a DPT and an SLT.
PBX

Super
Hybrid
Port

Cell Station

Wireless XDP
Parallel Mode

XDP Parallel Mode

DPT

Wireless Phone

PS

PT/SLT

Extn. 102

Extn. 103

Conditions
•

If one of the telephones goes off-hook while the other telephone is on a call, the call is
switched to the telephone going off-hook. However, the call is not switched in one of the
following conditions:

a) During a Conference call ( 1.13.1 Conference Features).
b) While Live Call Screening (LCS) or Two-way Record is activated (

1.23.3 Voice Mail

DPT (Digital) Integration).

c)
d)
e)
f)

•

While receiving OHCA (

1.7.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA)).

While being monitored by another extension (

1.7.3 Call Monitor).

During Consultation Hold.
During a broadcasting call (
TDA200 only)).

1.15.1 Broadcasting (KX-TDA30/KX-TDA100/KX-

(Consultation Hold: Allows an extension user to place a call on hold temporarily to
perform Call Transfer, Conference, or Call Splitting.)
Wireless XDP Parallel Mode can only be set from a PS. The wired telephone can accept
or deny this feature through COS programming ( Wireless XDP Parallel Mode for Paired
Telephone [515]). Once this feature is set, the setting at the wired telephone cannot be
changed unless a PS changes the setting.

Feature Guide

227

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

•

The following features are not available for extensions in Wireless XDP Parallel Mode
while the PS is on a call (however, they are available for the extensions in Wireless XDP
Parallel Mode while the wired telephone is on a call):
– Executive Busy Override
– Whisper OHCA ( 1.7.4.4 Whisper OHCA)
– CCBS ( 1.20.1.10 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS))

•

Most of the extension data (e.g., extension number, extension name) of the wired
telephone is used for its PS as well. However, the PS has its own extension data for the
following:
–
–
–
–
–
–
–

Ring Tone Pattern Table Selection ( 1.1.3.2 Ring Tone Pattern Selection)
Preferred Line Assignment—Incoming ( 1.4.1.2 Line Preference—Incoming)
Preferred Line Assignment—Outgoing ( 1.5.5.2 Line Preference—Outgoing)
Hot Line Setting ( 1.6.1.7 Hot Line)
Transfer Recall Destination for Call Transfer and Call Park
Display Language ( 1.19.4 Display Information)
ISDN Bearer Mode ( 1.20.1.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)—
SUMMARY)
– Flexible Button Assignment ( 1.19.2 Flexible Buttons)
Note
To change the setting of the extension data above, the setting for the wired telephone
or the PS must be changed individually. When changing the PS setting, use the PS’s
original extension number (not the main telephone’s extension number), if required.
•

When the Wireless XDP Parallel Mode has been set, the following extension data for the
wired telephone is copied to the PBX extension data for the PS and the extension data
remains there even when the Wireless XDP Parallel Mode is cancelled.
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–

Call Waiting Setting ( 1.1.3.3 Call Waiting)
FWD/DND Setting ( 1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND))
Call Pickup Deny Setting ( 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup)
Executive Busy Override Deny Setting
Itemised Billing Code for ARS ( 1.9.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS))
Transfer Recall Destination for Call Transfer and Call Park
CLIP/COLP Number ( CLIP/COLP Number [606])
CLIP/COLP Number Selection
CLIR Setting
COLR Setting
Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN) ( Extension Personal
Identification Number (PIN) [005]) ( 1.26.1 Extension Personal Identification
Number (PIN))
– COS Programming ( Class of Service [602]) ( 2.2.1 Class of Service (COS))
– User Group ( User Group [603]) ( 2.2.2 Group)
•
•

If the Extension Feature Clear is performed, the corresponding extension data for both the
wired telephone and the PS will be cleared. ( 1.26.2 Extension Feature Clear)
When a call arrives, both the wired telephone and the PS ring. However, in the following
cases only the person who made the setting will receive ringing:
– Automatic Callback Busy

228

Feature Guide

1.24 Portable Station (PS) Features

– Transfer Recall, Hold Recall (

1.12.1 Call Hold), and Call Park Recall

Feature Guide References
1.7.1 Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-on)
1.7.2 Executive Busy Override
1.10.9 Parallelled Telephone
1.11.1 Call Transfer
1.12.2 Call Park
1.20.1.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation (CLIP/COLP)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.12 Using Your PS in Parallel with a Wired Telephone (Wireless XDP Parallel Mode)

Feature Guide

229

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features
1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
Description
Automatically records detailed information for each extension.

1. SMDR Output Port
The Serial Interface (RS-232C) port can be used to output the SMDR data.
The following devices can be connected:
•
Serial Interface (RS-232C) port: Personal computer (PC), printer, etc.

2. SMDR Output Data
The following data will be recorded and sent to the SMDR output port:

a)
b)
c)
d)

Trunk call information (incoming/outgoing)
Intercom call information (outgoing)
Log-in/Log-out information
PBX error log (

2.4.3 Local Alarm Information)

Memory for SMDR: A specified number of call information can be memorised for each
PBX. If more calls are originated or received, the oldest data is overwritten by the newest
one.

230

Feature Guide

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

3. SMDR Format Type and Contents
There are the following three types of output format which can be selected through system
programming:
Pattern A: 80 digits without call charge information
Date
Time
(8 digits) (7)

Ext
(4)

CO Dial Number
(2) (25)

Ring Duration ACC Code
(4)
(8)
(10)

01/02/02 10:03AM
01/02/02 10:07AM
01/02/02 10:15AM
01/02/02 10:30AM

1200
1200
1200
*123

01
01
01
01

12345678901234567890

1234567890123456
1234567890123456

5'15
0'05

01/02/02 01:07PM
01/02/02 01:07PM
01/02/02 01:07PM
01/02/02 01:07PM
01/02/02 01:07PM

1234
1234
1234
1234
1234

01
01
01
01
01

ABC COMPANY12345678 0'05
CDE9876Q COMPANY 0'05
ABC COMPANY12345678
123..............
123456XX

01/02/02 08:33AM
01/02/02 01:07PM
01/02/02 03:35PM
01/02/02 03:45PM

1234
1234
1234
1234

(1)

(2)

(3)

CD
(3)

00:00'00
NA
00:01'05 9876543210
00:01'05 9876543210 TR
00:01'05 9876543210

00:01'05 9876543210
00:01'05 9876543210
00:01'05
00:01'05
00:12'05 98765

In the office
LOG IN
LOG OUT
EXT12355

(4)

(6)

(5)

(7)

(8)

(9)

ACC Code
(10)

CD
(3)

Pattern B: 80 digits with call charge information
Date
Time
(8 digits) (7)

Ext
(4)

CO Dial Number
(2) (20)

01/02/02 10:03AM 1210 01
01/02/02 10:07AM 2005 01

(1)

(2)

(3)

Duration Cost
(8)
(8+2)


NA
12345678901234567890 00:00'05 00560.00EU 9876543210

(4)

(7)

(5)

(10)

(8)

(9)

Pattern C: 120 digits
Date
Time
(8 digits) (7)

Ext
(4)

CO
(4)

Dial Number
(50)

Ring Duration Cost
(4) (8)
(8+3)

ACC Code CD
(10)
(3)

01/02/02 10:03AM 1230 0001 123456789012345678901234567890
00:00'05 00560.00EUR 9876543210 TR
01/02/02 10:07AM 1230 0001 ABC COMPANY123456789012345 0'05 00:00'05
9876543210 TR

(1)

(2)

(3)

(4)

(5)

(6)

(7)

(10)

(8)

Feature Guide

(9)

231

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

[Explanation]
The following table explains the SMDR contents which are based on the numbers in the
previous pattern examples. For the programmable items, refer to the following
[Programmable Items].
Number in
the
Pattern

Item

Description

(1)

Date

Shows the date of the call.

(2)

Time

Shows the end time of a call as Hour/Minute/AM or PM.

(3)

Ext
(Extension)

Shows the extension number, floating extension number,
etc., which was engaged in the call.
Also shows the following codes:
Dxxx: Outgoing trunk call from a doorphone
(xxx=doorphone number) ( 1.16.1 Doorphone Call)
Txxx: Outgoing trunk call by TIE line service (xxx=trunk
group number)
*xxx: Verified call (xxx=verified code) ( 1.8.6 Verified
Code Entry)

(4)

CO (Trunk)

Shows the trunk number used for the call.
For patterns A and B, "00" will be shown for trunk
numbers over hundred.

(5)

Dial Number

[Trunk Call]
Outgoing Trunk Call
Shows the dialled telephone number.
Valid digits are as follows:
0 through 9, , #
P: Pause
F: EFA signal
=: A Host PBX Access code ( 1.5.4.7 Host PBX Access
Code (Access Code to the Telephone Company from a
Host PBX))
. (dot): Secret dialling
X: Privacy dial
–: Transferred call
If the transfer destination extension enters some digits,
the entered digits will be added after "–".
Incoming Trunk Call
Shows  + the caller’s identification name/number.
It is also possible to show the DDI/DID/MSN call
information. In this case,  + DDI/DID/MSN
name/number is added before  .
[Outgoing Intercom Call]
Shows the dialled extension number followed by "EXT".
[Log-in/Log-out]
Shows the log-in or log-out status.

(6)

232

Feature Guide

Ring

Shows the ring duration before answering a call in
Minutes/Seconds.

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

Number in
the
Pattern

Item

Description

(7)

Duration

Shows the duration of the trunk call in Hours/Minutes/
Seconds.

(8)

Acc Code
(Account
Code)

Shows the account code appended to the call. (
Account Code Entry)

(9)

CD
(Condition
Code)

Shows other call information with the following codes:
CL: Collect call
TR: Transfer
FW: FWD to trunk
D0: Call using DISA or TIE line service
RM: Remote maintenance (modem) ( 2.3.1 PC
Programming)
NA: Not answered call
RC: Received call
AN: Answered call

(10)

Cost

Shows the call charge.

1.5.4.3

[Programmable Items]
Item

Description

Outgoing trunk call

Controls whether the outgoing trunk calls are shown. This
setting is common throughout the PBX ( SMDR Outgoing
Call Printing [804]). COS programming is also required.

Incoming trunk call

Controls whether the incoming trunk calls are shown (
SMDR Incoming Call Printing [805]).

Outgoing intercom
call

Controls whether the outgoing intercom calls are recorded.

Log-in/Log-out
status

Controls whether the log-in/log-out status is recorded.

ARS dial

Controls whether the user-dialled number or the modified
number is shown.
The Host PBX Access code ("=" followed by the access code)
can be shown (as supplementary information) only when the
modified number is selected in this setting. ( 1.9.1 Automatic
Route Selection (ARS))

Caller’s
identification

Controls whether the caller’s identification number, name,
number and name, or nothing is shown. If "none" is selected,
 will not be shown.

DID/DDI number

Controls whether the DID/DDI number, name, number and
name, or nothing is shown. If "none" is selected,  will not
be shown.

Feature Guide

233

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

Item

Description

Secret dialling

Controls secret dialling. If enabled, the dialled number will be
shown as dots.
This setting is effective only when the modified number is
selected in ARS dial setting above. If the user-dialled number
is selected in ARS dial setting, the dialled number will be
shown as dots regardless of this setting.

Privacy dial

Enables or disables privacy dial. If enabled, the last four digits
of the dialled telephone number and any additional digits after
connection will be shown as "X". (e.g., 123-456-XXXX)

Date order

The date order is changeable: month/day/year, day/month/
year, year/month/day, year/day/month.

Received call

Controls whether the time of receiving an incoming trunk call
is shown.

Answered call

Controls whether the time of answering an incoming trunk call
is shown.

Conditions
•

SMDR Format
The following SMDR format can be set through system programming in order to match the
paper size being used in the printer:

a) Page Length: determines the number of lines per page (

SMDR Page Length

[802]).

b) Skip Perforation: determines the number of lines to be skipped at the end of every
page ( SMDR Skip Perforation [803]).
The page length should be at least four lines longer than the skip perforation length.
Explanation:

Page
Length
Skip
Perforation

Machine
Perforation

•
•
•

The SMDR data is not deleted even if the PBX is reset.
If the PBX is reset during a conversation, the call will not be recorded on the SMDR.
The following calls are regarded as two separated calls in the SMDR:
– Calls before and after the flash/recall/EFA signal is manually sent during a
conversation
– Trunk-to-trunk calls by Call Transfer, FWD or DISA (recording each as "incoming
call" and "outgoing call")

234

Feature Guide

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

•

•

The PBX waits for a preprogrammed time period ( Call Duration Count Starting Time for
LCOT [208]) between the end of dialling and start of the SMDR timer for outgoing trunk
calls. When the PBX has sent out all dialled digits to the telephone company and this timer
expires, the PBX starts counting the call. A display PT shows the elapsed time of the call.
The starting time and the total duration of the call are recorded on SMDR.
If the reverse signal detection has been set ( 1.5.4.5 Reverse Circuit), the PBX will start
counting the call after detecting the reverse signal from the telephone company regardless
of the above timer.
Serial Interface (RS-232C) Parameters
The following communication parameters can be assigned for the Serial Interface (RS232C) port ( RS-232C Parameter—New Line Code [800], RS-232C Parameter—Baud
Rate [800], RS-232C Parameter—Word Length [800], RS-232C Parameter—Parity Bit
[800], RS-232C Parameter—Stop Bit Length [800]).

a) New Line Code: Select the code for the PC or printer. If the PC or printer
automatically feeds lines with carriage return, select "CR." If not, select "CR+LF."

b) Baud Rate: A baud rate code indicates the data transmission speed from the PBX to
the PC or printer.

c) Word Length: A word length code indicates how many bits compose a character.
d) Parity Bit: A parity code indicates what type of parity is used to detect an error in the
string of bits composing a character. Make an appropriate selection depending on the
requirements of the PC or printer.

e) Stop Bit Length: A stop bit code indicates the end of a bit string which composes a
character. Select an appropriate value depending on the requirements of the PC or
printer.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.11.1 Connection of Peripherals

6.10.1 Connection of Peripherals

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.3 Direct Inward Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI)
1.1.1.4 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) Ringing Service
1.2.2.6 Log-in/Log-out
1.11.1 Call Transfer
1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
1.28.1 TIE Line Service

Feature Guide

235

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

1.25.2 Charge Meter
Description
The PBX receives a call charge signal during or after a conversation with an outside party. The
call charge information is shown on the telephone display and the SMDR.

1. Call Charge Signal Service
Call charge signal service from the telephone company depends on the trunk being used.
Trunk

Service

Analogue trunk

Pay Tone (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)*

ISDN line

Advice of Charge (AOC) (
Charge (AOC))

E1 line

Meter Pulse (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)

1.20.1.3 Advice of

*: When the pay tone service is used, pay tone type (12 kHz/16 kHz) should be
selected ( Pay Tone Signal Type [491] (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)).

2. Call Charge Display
– Up to 7 digits (e.g., 88888.75)
– The decimal point position (the number of significant decimal digits) for currency is
programmable. ( Decimal Point Position for Currency [130])
– Up to 3 currency characters are programmable. (e.g., EUR or for Euro) (
Currency [131]).
– The currency position either front or back of the call charge is programmable. (e.g.,
45.12 or 45.12 )

3. Margin/Tax Rate Assignment
It is possible to add a margin ( Charge Margin [010]) and the tax ( Charge Tax [011])
to the call charges. The call charge rate per meter indication is programmable on a trunk
group basis ( Charge Rate per Unit [012]).
[Calculation Method]
The margin or tax rate must be xx.xx % (whole number part: two digits, decimal fraction:
two digits). A calculation method depends on the information which is sent from the
telephone company: meter indication or charge.

a) Call charge with tax and margin in meter indication:
[Meter indication received from the telephone company]
[1 – Tax Rate]

[Call Charge Rate]

[1 – Margin Rate]

b) Call charge with tax and margin in charge:
[Charge received from the telephone company]
[1 – Tax Rate]

[Call Charge Rate]

[1 – Margin Rate]

The calculation result is rounded up to the least significant decimal digit.

236

Feature Guide

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

4. Total Call Charge
– A PT user can show the total call charges on the display.
– The call charge is totalled on an extension, trunk, or verified code basis.
– The call charge on a verified code is not totalled for each extension.

5. Budget Management
It is possible to limit telephone usage to a preprogrammed budget on each extension or
verified code. For example, an extension in a rented office has a prepaid limit for the
telephone usage. If the amount of the call charge reaches the limit, the extension user
cannot make further trunk calls. An extension assigned as the manager may increase the
limit or clear the previous call charge ( 1.8.2 Budget Management).

6. Call Charge Management
A manager can use the following call charge management features in manager
programming mode:

a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)

Call Charge Fee Reference and Clear, for Each Extension/Verified Code
Call Charge Fee Reference for Each Trunk
Call Charge Rate Set for Each Trunk Group
All Clear
Call Charge Fee Print Out
Budget Management for Each Extension/Verified Code.

[Examples of Call Charge Fee Reference]
******************************************************
* Charge Meter Print Out - Total & All CO
*
******************************************************
Total Charge:
00175.95
CO Line
001:

003:

00161.00

*******************************************************
* Charge Meter Print Out - All Extensions
*
*******************************************************
Extension & Verified Code
*775:
00194.00
*102:
00073.00
*776:

00161.00

106:

00161.00

104:

00194.00

00194.00

002:

105:

00073.00

00073.00

004:

00033.00

(Verified Code)
107:

00033.00

Note: *XXX: Call Charge Fee Reference for a verified code (XXX = verified code)

Feature Guide

237

1.25 Administrative Information Output Features

Conditions
[General]
•

Call Charge Fee Reference by Charge Reference Button
A display telephone user can check the total call charge for his own extension using the
Charge Reference button. A flexible button can be customised as the Charge Reference
button.

[Pay Tone Service (KX-TDA100/KX-TDA200 only)]
•
•

It is possible to select whether the PBX starts counting the call charge from when the PBX
detects the answer signal from the telephone company.
It is possible to enable the PBX to send the flash/recall signal to the telephone company
after a conversation (in on-hook status) to receive the call charge information.

Feature Guide References
1.8.6 Verified Code Entry
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
3.2.2 Manager Programming

238

Feature Guide

1.26 Extension Controlling Features

1.26 Extension Controlling Features
1.26.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN)
Description
Each extension user can have his own PIN through system programming ( Extension
Personal Identification Number (PIN) [005]) or personal programming (Extension PIN
[Personal Identification Number]) to set features or access his own telephone remotely.
The following features cannot be used without the PIN:

a) Live Call Screening (LCS)* ( 1.23.3 Voice Mail DPT (Digital) Integration)
b) Incoming and Outgoing Call Log Display Lock ( 1.17.2 Incoming Call Log),
Personal Speed Dialling Display Lock (

1.6.1.5 Speed Dialling—Personal/System)

c) Walking Extension ( 1.26.3 Walking Extension)
d) Extension Lock ( 1.8.3 Extension Lock)
e) Remote Extension Control ( 1.26.5 Remote Extension Control by User) and
Walking COS (

f)

1.8.5 Walking COS)

Remote Extension Control and Walking COS using DISA (
System Access (DISA))

1.16.6 Direct Inward

*: If an extension user has assigned an extension PIN, this feature cannot be used without
the PIN.

Conditions
WARNING
When a third party discovers the personal identification number (PIN) (verified code PIN/
extension PIN) of the PBX, there will be a risk that they will make fraudulent phone calls
using the telephone line, and the cost will be charged to your own account. In order to
avoid this problem, we strongly recommend the following points:

a) Carefully maintain the secrecy of the PIN.
b) Specify a complicated PIN as long and random as you can make it.
c) Change the PIN frequently.
•

•

•

Extension PIN Lock
If the wrong PIN is entered incorrectly three times, the line will be disconnected. If the
incorrect PIN is entered a preprogrammed number of times successively, the PIN against
the extension will be locked. Only an extension assigned as the manager can unlock it. In
this case, the PIN will be unlocked and cleared.
This feature is also known as Station Password Lock.
Remote Extension PIN Clear
If an extension user forgets his PIN, a manager can clear the PIN. Then the extension user
can assign a new PIN.
Extension PIN Display
It is possible to select whether to show the extension PIN on the display through system
programming. By default, it is shown as dots.

Feature Guide

239

1.26 Extension Controlling Features

User Manual References
User Manual
3.1.2 Settings on the Programming Mode
3.2.2 Manager Programming

240

Feature Guide

1.26 Extension Controlling Features

1.26.2 Extension Feature Clear
Description
Extension users can clear all the following features set on their own telephone at once:
Features

After Setting

Absent Message

Off

BGM

Off

FWD*/DND*

Off

Call Pickup Deny

Allow

Call Waiting*

Disable (In Canada, the default setting is
"Enable" [Call Waiting tone].)

Data Line Security

Off

Executive Busy Override Deny

Allow

Log-in/Log-out

Log-in

Message Waiting

All messages left by other extensions
will be cleared.

Paging Deny

Allow

Parallelled Telephone

Paired SLT will ring.

Hot Line*

Off

Timed Reminder

Cleared

Note: The features with "*" can be programmed not to be cancelled by this feature.
This feature is also known as Station Programme Clear.

Conditions
•

•

Extension Lock ( 1.8.3 Extension Lock) and the extension personal identification
number (PIN) ( 1.26.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN)) will not be
cleared by this feature.
For Users in Canada only
If dial tone 2 is heard after Extension Feature Clear:
After performing Extension Feature Clear, Call Waiting will be enabled if "Extension
Clear: Call Waiting" is set to "Clear" through system programming. In this case,
dial tone 2 will be heard when going off-hook. ( 1.27.1 Dial Tone)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.13 Clearing Features Set at Your Extension (Extension Feature Clear)

Feature Guide

241

1.26 Extension Controlling Features

1.26.3 Walking Extension
Description
It is possible to use any extension and have your extension settings available to you. Settings
such as extension number, one-touch dialling memory, and COS are all available to you at the
new location.
[Example] This feature is useful when;
•
Moving location
•
There is no specific desk for your use.
This feature is also known as Walking Station.

Conditions
•
•
•
•

This feature is available by switching the telephone between PT and PT, SLT and SLT, PT
and SLT. Moving across the tenants is also possible.
The incoming calls to your extension will also reach you at your new location.
An extension personal identification number (PIN) is required to use this feature. (
1.26.1 Extension Personal Identification Number (PIN))
If a DSS Console is connected to a PT and the DSS Console is continuously used with the
PT after the Walking Extension has been done, the new extension number of the PT must
be assigned as the paired extension through system programming ( Console Paired
Telephone [007]).

User Manual References
User Manual
1.10.1 Using the Same Settings as Your Previous Extension (Walking Extension)

242

Feature Guide

1.26 Extension Controlling Features

1.26.4 Timed Reminder
Description
Each extension user can set an alarm for any time as a wake-up call or reminder. This feature
can be programmed to activate only once or daily. If the user goes off-hook during the alarm,
he hears special dial tone. If a voice message is used, he hears a prerecorded voice message.

Conditions
•
•
•

•

Be sure that the PBX clock works.
Setting a new time clears the previous time.
Programmable Time
The Alarm Ringing Duration time, the number of alarm repeat times, and intervals are
programmable through system programming.
To use the voice message feature:
The MSG card is required and the message must be recorded. An extension assigned as
the manager can record messages. ( 1.16.5 Outgoing Message (OGM)) The different
message can be assigned for each time mode (day/lunch/break/night) ( 2.2.4 Time
Service).

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.6.5 MSG4 Card

6.5.4 MSG2 Card

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.1 Setting the Alarm (Timed Reminder)

Feature Guide

243

1.26 Extension Controlling Features

1.26.5 Remote Extension Control by User
Description
A user can remotely change the feature settings (e.g., FWD) and time service mode for his own
extension from inside or outside the PBX using DISA ( 1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access
(DISA)). This feature can be used only on the extensions which are allowed to be controlled
remotely on a COS basis.
The following features are available:

a)
b)
c)
d)
e)

FWD/DND (

1.3.1 Call Forwarding (FWD)/Do Not Disturb (DND))

Log-in/Log-out (
Absent Message (
Extension Lock (

1.2.2.6 Log-in/Log-out)
1.18.2 Absent Message)
1.8.3 Extension Lock)

Time Service—Changing the Time Mode (day/lunch/break/night) (
Service)
This feature is also known as Remote Station Control by User.

2.2.4 Time

Conditions
•

•

Extension PIN
An extension personal identification number (PIN) ( Extension Personal Identification
Number (PIN) [005]) is required to use this feature. ( 1.26.1 Extension Personal
Identification Number (PIN)) If the wrong PIN is entered three times, the line will be
disconnected.
Remote operation is not available for the extensions in the Internal Call Block mode. (
1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block)

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.9 Setting Your Telephone from Another Extension or through DISA (Remote Setting)

244

Feature Guide

1.27 Audible Tone Features

1.27 Audible Tone Features
1.27.1 Dial Tone
Description
The following dial tones inform extensions about features activated on the extensions:
Each dial tone type has two frequencies (e.g., dial tone 1A and dial tone 1B).
Type

Description

Tone 1A/1B

A normal dial tone is heard when:
a) No features listed for dial tones 2 through 4 has been set, or
b) ARS is used.

Tone 2A/2B

Any one of the features below is set.
•
Absent Message
•
BGM
•
FWD
•
Call Pickup Deny
•
Call Waiting
•
DND
•
Extension Lock
•
Executive Busy Override Deny
•
Hot Line
•
Timed Reminder

Tone 3A/3B

While a called PS is being searched, or any one of the features
below is performed.
•
Account Code Entry
•
Consultation Hold
•
Answering a Timed Reminder call with no message

Tone 4A/4B

Messages are waiting for the extension.

Conditions
•

•
•
•

Dial Tone Type A/B
It is possible to select dial tone type A or B for dial tones 1 through 4. If "Type A" is
selected, all dial tones 1 through 4 will become dial tone type A.
The dial tone type for the ARS feature can be selected separately. If "Type A" is selected
for the ARS, dial tone 1A will be heard. If "Type B" is selected, dial tone 1B will be heard.
Distinctive Dial tone
Distinctive dial tone mode can be disabled. In this case, dial tone 1 will be sent.
Dial Tone Patterns
All dial tone patterns have a default ( 4.2.1 Tones/Ring Tones).
Only dial tone 1 is sent to the extensions in the VM (DPT/DTMF) group. ( 1.23.1 Voice
Mail (VM) Group)

Feature Guide

245

1.27 Audible Tone Features

1.27.2 Confirmation Tone
Description
At the end of feature operations, the PBX confirms the success of the operation by sending a
confirmation tone to extension users.
Type

Description

Tone 1

a) Sent when the setting is accepted.
b) Sent when a call is received in voice-calling mode (Alternate
Receiving—Ring/Voice). The caller’s voice will be heard after
the tone.

Tone 2

a) Sent from an external paging device or an extension before
being paged.
b) Sent when a call is received in Hands-free Answerback
mode.

Tone 3-1

a) Sent before a conversation is established when using the
Paging feature.
b) Sent when a conversation is established with the extension in
the following modes after the call making operation:
•
Hands-free Answerback mode
•
Voice-calling mode (Alternate Receiving—Ring/Voice)

Tone 3-2

Sent just before a conversation is established when accessing
the following features by the feature numbers:
•
Call Park Retrieve
•
Call Pickup
•
Hold Retrieve
•
Paging Answer
•
TAFAS

Tone 4-1

Sent when moving from a two-party call to a three-party call.
(e.g., Executive Busy Override, Conference, Privacy Release,
Two-way Record.)

Tone 4-2

Sent when moving from a three-party call to a two-party call.
(e.g., Executive Busy Override, Conference, Privacy Release,
Two-way Record.)

Tone 5

Sent when a call is placed on hold (including Consultation Hold).

Conditions
•
•

246

Feature Guide

Confirmation Tone Patterns
All confirmation tone patterns have a default (
It is possible to eliminate each tone.

4.2.1 Tones/Ring Tones).

1.28 Networking Features

1.28 Networking Features
1.28.1 TIE Line Service
Description
A TIE line is a privately leased communication line between two or more PBXs, which provides
cost effective communications between company members at different locations. The TIE lines
can be used to call through the PBX to reach another switching system (PBX or telephone
company). By using TIE lines, the PBX can support not only communications with the public
network but with other company members in the private network where the PBX is included.

Interface
The following interfaces can be used to establish a private network:
Interface

Network Type

E&M

Analogue

T1 (TIE [E & M])

Digital (64 kbps × 24 channels)

E1 (E & M)

Digital (64 kbps × 30 channels)

BRI/PRI (QSIG)

Digital (ISDN 2B+D/30B+D/23B+D)

VoIP

Internet Protocol (IP)

A trunk which is used for a private network should be assigned "Private" as the networking
type. ( 1.1.1.1 Incoming Trunk Call Features—SUMMARY)

Explanation
1. Making a TIE Line Call
One of the following two methods can be used to make a TIE line call.

a) Extension Number Method (Access without PBX Code)
Dial the [Extension Number] only.

Feature Guide

247

1.28 Networking Features

[Example]
PBX-1
TIE Line
Interface

Extn.1011

TIE Line
Interface Interface

Extn.1012

Dials "3011".

PBX-3

PBX-2

Interface

Extn. 3011

Extn. 2011

Dials "2011".

Explanation:
To use this method, it is necessary to change the first one or two digits of extension
numbers of either PBX (e.g., 10XX for PBX-1, 20XX for PBX-2) to avoid having the
same extension number.
Case 1:
Extension 1012 of PBX-1 dials extension number "2011".
Extension 1012 of PBX-1 is connected to extension "2011" of PBX-2.
Case 2:
Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials extension number "3011".
Extension 1011 of PBX-1 is connected to extension "3011" of PBX-3.

b) PBX Code Method (Access with PBX Code)
Dial the [TIE Line Access Number] + [PBX Code] + [Extension Number].
[Example]
PBX-1

PBX-2

PBX-3

PBX Code 951

PBX Code 952

PBX Code 953

TIE Line
Interface

Extn.1011

Dials "7-953-1011".

Extn.1012

Extn. 1011

Dials "7-952-1011".
[PBX code]
[TIE line
access no.]
[Extn. no.]

248

Feature Guide

TIE Line
Interface Interface

Interface

Extn. 1011

1.28 Networking Features

Explanation:
To use this method, it is necessary to know each PBX code in order to identify the
location of an extension.
Case 1:
Extension 1012 of PBX-1 dials TIE line access number "7", PBX code "952", and
extension number "1011".
Extension 1012 of PBX-1 is connected to extension "1011" of PBX-2.
Case 2:
Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials TIE line access number "7", PBX code "953", and
extension number "1011".
Extension 1011 of PBX-1 is connected to extension "1011" of PBX-3.

2. TIE Line Routing and Modification Table
2.1 To Make a TIE Line Call
The TIE Line Routing and Modification Table is referenced by the PBX to identify the
trunk route when an extension user makes a TIE line call.
It is necessary to make unified tables with all PBXs in the TIE line network.
The routing pattern appropriate for each call is decided by the dialled number.
There are two system programmes for the tables:
TIE Line Routing Table: used to assign the leading numbers (PBX code or extension
number) and trunk group hunt sequence.
TIE Modify Removed Number of Digits/Added Number: used to remove digits
from and add a number to the dialled number of the TIE line call. This modification
may be needed depending on the TIE line network configuration.
[Programming Examples]
Your PBX is PBX-1 and there are four PBXs in your TIE line network. To identify the
trunk route as illustrated, you should make the following tables.
a) Extension Number Method (Access without PBX Code)

TIE Line Network
PBX-4

PBX-3

Extn. 4xxx

If you dial:
a) 2xxx

Extn. 3xxx

b-2nd) 3xxx
TRG 2 c) 4xxx

b) 3xxx
c) 4xxx
(2, 3, 4: Other PBX
Extension Number
[TIE] in the Flexible
Numbering Plan)

TRG 1
a) 2xxx
b-1st) 3xxx

Extn. 1xxx

PBX-1

Extn. 2xxx

PBX-2

Feature Guide

249

1.28 Networking Features

[TIE Line Routing and Modification Table of PBX-1]
Priority 1

Priority 2

..

Dial Modification
Dial Modification . .
Location Leading
Trunk Removed
Trunk Removed
No.
No.
Group No. of Added Group No. of Added . .
No.
No.
Digits
Digits
01

2

1

0

02

3

1

0

03

4

2

0

:

:

:

:

..
2

0

..
..

:

:

:

:

:

Explanation:
Location 01: The hunt sequence by dialling [2XXX]:
The 1st route—trunk group (TRG) 1

Sending no. to PBX-2: 2XXX

Location 02: The hunt sequence by dialling [3XXX]:
The 1st route—trunk group (TRG) 1

Sending no. to PBX-2: 3XXX

The 2nd route—trunk group (TRG) 2

Sending no. to PBX-4: 3XXX

Location 03: The hunt sequence by dialling [4XXX]:
The 1st route—trunk group (TRG) 2

Sending no. to PBX-4: 4XXX

b) PBX Code Method (Access with PBX Code)

TIE Line Network
PBX-4

PBX-3

PBX Code 954

PBX Code 953

Extn. xxxx

If you dial:
a) 7-952-xxxx
b) 7-953-xxxx

Extn. xxxx

b-2nd)
953#-xxxx
c)
954#-xxxx
TRG 2
TRG 1

c) 7-954-xxxx
(7: TIE Line Access
Number in the
Flexible
Numbering Plan)

250

Feature Guide

a) 952-xxxx
b-1st) 953-xxxx

Extn. 1xxx

PBX-1
PBX Code 951

Extn. xxxx

PBX-2

PBX Code 952

1.28 Networking Features

[TIE Line Routing and Modification Table of PBX-1]
Priority 1
Dial Modification
Location Leading
Trunk Removed
No.
No.
Added
Group No. of
No.
Digits
01

952

1

0

02

953

1

0

03

954

2

3

954#

:

:

:

:

:

Priority 2

..

Dial Modification

..

Trunk Removed
Group No. of
Digits

Added
No.

..
..

2

3

953# . .
..

:

:

:

:

Explanation:
Location 01: The hunt sequence by dialling [7+PBX Code 952+XXXX]:
The 1st route — trunk group (TRG) 1
Sending no. to PBX-2: 952–XXXX
Location 02: The hunt sequence by dialling [7+PBX Code 953+XXXX]:
The 1st route — trunk group (TRG) 1
Sending no. to PBX-2: 953–XXXX
The 2nd route — trunk group (TRG) 2
Sending no. to PBX-4:

953#–XXXX

Location 03: The hunt sequence by dialling [7+PBX Code 954+XXXX]:
The 1st route — trunk group (TRG) 2
Sending no. to PBX-4:

954#–XXXX

Feature Guide

251

1.28 Networking Features

2.2 To Receive a TIE Line Call
a) Extension Number Method (Access without PBX Code)
[Example]
TIE Line Network
PBX-4

1

A TIE line call is sent to PBX-2
from PBX-1. If the number sent
from PBX-1 is an extension
number of PBX-2 (e.g., 2011),
the call will be received at
extension "2011". If not, PBX-2
checks the number in the TIE
Line Routing and Modified
Table of PBX-2.

2

If the match is found in the
table, the call will be modified
according to the table and send
to the corresponding PBX
(PBX-3).

3

The number sent from PBX-2
"3011" is an extension number
of PBX-3. The call is received
at extension "3011".

PBX-3
3
Extn. 3011

2 3011
1 3011

Extn. 2011

Extn. 1011
Dials "3011".

PBX-1

PBX-2

Note
When a TIE line call is sent to a PBX from another PBX, first the PBX modifies
the number sent to the PBX according to the assignment for each trunk port of
the PBX: the removed number of digits from and/or added number to the number
sent to the PBX is determined by the assignment. Then the PBX starts to check
the number whether the number is an extension number of the PBX.

252

Feature Guide

1.28 Networking Features

b) PBX Code Method (Access with PBX Code)
[Example]
TIE Line Network
PBX-4

1

A TIE line call is sent to PBX-2
from PBX-1. If the number sent
from PBX-1 has the PBX code
of PBX-2 "952", the call will be
received at the corresponding
extension of PBX-2 (e.g.,
1011of PBX-2). If not, PBX-2
checks the number in the TIE
Line Routing and Modified
Table of PBX-2.

2

If the match is found in the
table, the call will be modified
according to the table and send
to the corresponding PBX
(PBX-3).

3

The number sent from PBX-2
"953-1011" has the PBX code
of PBX-3 "953". The call is
received at extension "1011" of
PBX-3.

PBX-3

PBX Code 953

PBX Code 954

3
Extn. 1011

2 953-1011
1 953-1011

Extn. 1011

Extn. 1011
PBX-1

Dials "7-953-1011". PBX Code 951

PBX-2
PBX Code 952

Note
When a TIE line call is sent to a PBX from another PBX, first the PBX modifies
the number sent to the PBX according to the assignment for each trunk port of
the PBX: the removed number of digits from and/or added number to the number
sent to the PBX is determined by the assignment. Then the PBX starts to check
the number whether the number has the PBX code of the PBX.

3. TIE Line and Trunk Connection
To connect the TIE line with the trunk, the following patterns are available:
1) Trunk-to-TIE Access
2) TIE-to-Trunk Access
3) Trunk-to-TIE-to-Trunk Access
3.1 Trunk-to-TIE Access
It is possible to assign an extension of another PBX as the destination of incoming
trunk calls to the own PBX.

Feature Guide

253

1.28 Networking Features

a) Incoming Trunk Call Destination Assignment
[Example]

Telephone Company

Trunk

TIE Line Network

PBX-1
Trunk

PBX-2

DID No: 123-4567
Destination: 2011

TIE Line
Interface

Interface

Outside Caller
Dials "123-4567".

Extn. 2011

Extn. 1011

(DID No.:123-4567)

Explanation:
An outside caller dials the DID number "123-4567". The call is sent to extension
"2011" of PBX-2 through the TIE line according to the assignment of the DID call
destination ( DID Destination [453]) of PBX-1. ( 1.1.1.3 Direct Inward
Dialling (DID)/Direct Dialling In (DDI))
b) FWD/Call Transfer/Intercept Routing to the TIE Line
[Example]

Telephone Company

Trunk

TIE Line Network

PBX-1

PBX-2

Trunk

TIE Line
Interface

Interface

Forwarded/Transferred
/Intercepted to 2011

Outside Caller
Extn. 1011
Dials "123-4567".

254

Feature Guide

(DID No.: 123-4567)

Extn. 2011

1.28 Networking Features

Explanation:
An outside caller dials the DID number "123-4567". The call reaches the
destination (extension 1011 of PBX-1), and the call is forwarded, transferred, or
intercepted to extension "2011" of PBX-2 through the TIE line.
3.2 TIE-to-Trunk Access
The PBX sends TIE line calls to the trunks of another PBX through the TIE lines.
a) Trunk Call through Other PBXs—by Making a TIE Line Call Method
[Example]


Telephone Company

Trunk

01-23-4567

Trunk

TIE Line Network
PBX-2

PBX-1
9-01-23-4567
Interface

TIE Line
TRG 2

Interface

Outside Party
Extn. 1011

Extn. 2011

(01-23-4567)

Dials "802-9-01-23-4567".

Explanation:
1. Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials the Trunk Group Access number of PBX-1 "8",
trunk group number "02" (TRG2), Idle Line Access number of PBX-2 "9", and
telephone number "01-23-4567".
2. PBX-1 sends the call to PBX-2 through the trunk group (TRG) 2 (TIE line).
3. PBX-2 sends the call to the outside party "01-23-4567".

Feature Guide

255

1.28 Networking Features



Telephone Company

Trunk

01-23-4567

Trunk

TIE Line Network
PBX-1

PBX-2

PBX Code 951

PBX Code 952

952-9-01-23-4567
Interface

TIE Line
TRG 2

Interface

Outside Party
Extn. 1011

Extn. 1011

(01-23-4567)

Dials "7-952-9-01-23-4567" or
"802-952-9-01-23-4567".

Explanation:
1. Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials the TIE line access number "7", PBX code
"952", Idle Line Access number of PBX-2 "9", and telephone number "01-234567"; or dials the Trunk Group Access number of PBX-1 "8", trunk group
number "02" (TRG2), PBX code "952", Idle Line Access number of PBX-2
"9", and telephone number "01-23-4567".
2. The call is connected to the outside party "01-23-4567" through PBX-2 which
has PBX code "952".

256

Feature Guide

1.28 Networking Features

b) Trunk Call through Other PBXs—by the ARS feature
[Example]


Telephone Company

Trunk

01-23-4567

Trunk

TIE Line Network
PBX-2

PBX-1
9-01-23-4567
Interface

TIE Line
TRG 2

Interface

Outside Party
Extn. 1011

Extn. 2011

(01-23-4567)

Dials "9-01-23-4567".

Explanation:
1. Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials the Idle Line Access number of PBX-1 "9" and
telephone number "01-23-4567".
2. PBX-1 modifies the call (adds the Idle Line Access number of PBX-2 "9") and
sends the call to PBX-2 through the TIE line (trunk group [TRG] 2) according
to the ARS programming of PBX-1.
3. PBX-2 sends the call to the outside party "01-23-4567".

Feature Guide

257

1.28 Networking Features



Telephone Company

Trunk

01-23-4567

Trunk

TIE Line Network
PBX-1

PBX-2

PBX Code 951

PBX Code 952

952-9-01-23-4567
Interface

TIE Line
TRG 2

Interface

Outside Party
Extn. 1011

Extn. 1011

(01-23-4567)

Dials "9-01-23-4567".

Explanation:
1. Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials the Idle Line Access number of PBX-1 "9" and
telephone number "01-23-4567".
2. PBX-1 modifies the call (adds "952" and the Idle Line Access number of PBX2 "9") and sends the call to PBX-2 which has PBX code "952" through the TIE
line (trunk group [TRG] 2) according to the ARS programming of PBX-1.
3. PBX-2 sends the call to the outside party "01-23-4567".

258

Feature Guide

1.28 Networking Features

c) Blocking of Trunk Call through Other PBXs and How to Override It
To prohibit a TIE line call to go through PBX-2 for making a trunk call, if PBX-2
is Panasonic Hybrid IP-PBX (e.g., KX-TDA100 or KX-TDA200), PBX-2 should
disable the trunk group of the outgoing call from PBX-2 against the COS of the
trunk group of the incoming call to PBX-2 ( Trunk Group Number [500]) like
the programming example shown below. TRS/Barring applies to a TIE line call
on a COS of the trunk group of the incoming call basis. To override this
prohibition, access the DISA floating extension number of PBX-2 and enter a
verified code to change the COS temporarily.
[Programming Example of PBX-2]

Trunk Group No.

COS No.

1

3

2

2

3

2

:

:

TRG of Incoming
Call

Outgoing Call
TRG 1

TRG 2

TRG 3

…

:

:

:

:

COS 1
COS 2
COS 3
:
: Block

Feature Guide

259

1.28 Networking Features

[Example]

Telephone Company

Trunk

Trunk
01-23-4567

TRG 3
of PBX-2

TIE Line Network
PBX-1

PBX-2

PBX-Code 951

Interface

952-9-01-23-4567

TIE Line
TRG 2
of PBX-1

TRG 1 (COS 3)
of PBX-2

PBX-Code 952

Interface DISA

952-(DISA Floating extn. no. +
verified code entry feature no. + +
verified code + verified code
PIN)-9-01-23-4567

Outside Party
(01-23-4567)

Extn. 1011

Extn. 1012

Dials "7-952-9-0123-4567".

Dials "7-952-(DISA Floating extn. no. +
verified code entry feature no. + +
verified code + verified code PIN)
-9-01-23-4567".

Explanation:
Case 1:
1. Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials the TIE line access number "7", PBX code
"952", Idle Line Access number of PBX-2 "9", and telephone number "01-234567".
2. The call is not connected to the outside party "01-23-4567" through PBX-2
which has PBX code "952" due to the COS assignment of the trunk groups
of PBX-2.
Case 2:
1. Extension 1012 of PBX-1 dials the TIE line access number "7", PBX code
"952", "DISA floating extension number of PBX-2 + verified code entry
feature number + + verified code + verified code personal identification
number (PIN)", Idle Line Access number of PBX-2 "9", and telephone number
"01-23-4567".
2. The call overrides the COS assignment of the trunk groups of PBX-2, and the
call is connected to the outside party "01-23-4567" through PBX-2 which has
PBX code "952".

260

Feature Guide

1.28 Networking Features

d) FWD/Call Transfer/Intercept Routing to the Trunk
[Example]

Telephone Company

Trunk

Forwarded/Transferred/
Intercepted to 01-23-4567

Trunk

TIE Line Network
PBX-1

PBX-2

PBX-Code 951

PBX-Code 952

Interface

952-1011

TIE Line

Extn. 1011

Interface

Extn. 1011

Outside Party
(01-23-4567)

Dials "7-952-1011".

Explanation:
1. Extension 1011 of PBX-1 dials the TIE line access number "7", PBX code
"952", and extension number "1011".
2. The call reaches the destination (extension 1011 of PBX-2) through the TIE
line, and the call is forwarded, transferred or intercepted to the outside party
"01-23-4567" through the trunk.

Feature Guide

261

1.28 Networking Features

3.3 Trunk-to-TIE-to-Trunk Access
An outside caller can be connected to an outside party through the TIE line by using
the DISA feature.
[Example]

Telephone Company

Trunk
Trunk

TIE Line Network

Trunk

PBX-1

PBX-2

PBX-Code 951

PBX-Code 952

01-234567

Trunk

952-9-01-23-4567
DISA Interface

TIE Line

Interface

TRG 2
Outside Party

Outside Caller

(01-23-4567)

Dials "(DISA phone
number)-9-01-234567".

Extn. 1011

Extn. 1011

Explanation:
1. The outside caller dials the "DISA phone number of PBX-1", Idle Line Access
number of PBX-1 "9", and telephone number "01-23-4567".
2. PBX-1 modifies the call (adds "952" and the Idle Line Access number of PBX2 "9") and sends the call to PBX-2 which has PBX code "952" through the TIE
line (trunk group [TRG] 2) according to the ARS programming of PBX-1.
3. PBX-2 sends the call to the outside party "01-23-4567".

262

Feature Guide

1.28 Networking Features

4. TIE Line Routing Flowchart
[Making a TIE Line Call from an Extension]
A TIE line call is made as follows:
PBX Code Method: 7-abc-xxxx
Extension No. Method: dexx

Is the dialled number
identified as a TIE line access no.
or an other PBX extension no. in
the flexible numbering
plan of the own PBX?

No

Not treated as
a TIE line call.

Yes:

A

TIE line access no.: 7
Other PBX extension no.: de

Is the leading
number (abc or de) found in the TIE Line
Routing and Modification Table
of the own PBX?

No
Reorder tone

Yes
Selects the corresponding trunk group, and
the dialled number is modified if a removed
number of digits and/or added number is assigned.

Is the trunk group
available?

No
Reorder tone

Yes

Is there an idle trunk
in the trunk group?

No
Busy tone

Yes
Routes to other PBX or trunk.

Feature Guide

263

1.28 Networking Features

[Receiving a Call through a TIE Line]





A call is received through a
TIE line as follows:

A call is received through a
TIE line as follows:

# 1021

## 0511033

The received number is modified as
programmed for each trunk port.

The received number is modified as
programmed for each trunk port.

Removed number of digits: 1
Added number: None
Received number: # 1021

Removed number of digits: 3
Added number: 9
Received number: ## 0511033

Modified number: # 1021=1021

Modified number: ##0511033= 9511033

Remove the first 1 digit.

1) Remove the first 3 digits.

2) Add "9".

No

Does the modified number have
the own PBX code "951"?
Yes: 9511033
Removes the own PBX
code "951".
1021

1033

Goes to

A

( A is in the
flowchart of [Making
a TIE Line Call from an
Extension].)

Checks the modified number with the flexible numbering plan of the own PBX.
Operator Call No.

Extension No.
of the Own PBX

Extension No.
of Other PBX

Directs the call
to the operator.

Goes to
Does the corresponding
extension exist?
Yes

No

Is the corresponding
extension idle?
Yes
Calls the extension.

Call Waiting
Busy tone
Intercept Routing
—Busy/DND

264

Feature Guide

No

A

Idle Line
Access No.
or
Trunk Group
Access No.

( A is in the flowchart of
[Making a TIE Line Call
from an Extension].)
Is the trunk
group of the outgoing
call from the own PBX enabled
against the COS of the trunk group of
the incoming call
to the own PBX?

Sends reorder
tone, or sends the
call to the operator
(Intercept Routing
—No Destination).

Yes
TRS/Barring applies.

Sends the call to
the trunk.

Others
Reorder tone.

No

Reorder
tone

1.28 Networking Features

Conditions
•
•

When a TIE line call arrives at a busy extension which has disabled Call Waiting, the caller
will hear a busy tone. If required, Intercept Routing—Busy/DND can be activated.
The Inter-digit time can be assigned for TIE line calls.

Feature Guide References
1.1.1.6 Intercept Routing
1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)
1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring)
1.9.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
1.11.1 Call Transfer
1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
2.3.5 Flexible Numbering/Fixed Numbering

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.1 Basic Calling

Feature Guide

265

1.28 Networking Features

1.28.2 Virtual Private Network (VPN)
Description
Virtual Private Network (VPN) is a service provided by the telephone company. It uses an
existing line as if it were a private line. There is no need to set up a private line or to lease a
line from the telephone company. Making and receiving both public and private calls is possible
using the same line.
Public/Private Discrimination:

a) When making a call: The public/private discrimination number is required before
sending the dialled number to the telephone company. The public/private
discrimination number can be dialled manually, or automatically by ARS programming
( 1.9.1 Automatic Route Selection (ARS)) and/or TIE line service programming.

b) When receiving a call: The telephone company distinguishes the call type. If it is a
private call, the call is received by the TIE line service method. If it is a public call, the
call is received by the Incoming Trunk Call Distribution method (DIL/DDI/MSN) which
is assigned on the trunk.
[Example]

Public ISDN



VPN

9-0-01-23-4567

01-23-4567

Public No.


PBX-1
PBX Code 111

Head
Office

113-401
Private No.

Extn. 201 Extn. 202

Dials "9-01-23-4567".
(ARS)

Dials "401".
(TIE)

Dials
"01-45-6789".
PBX-2

PBX-3

PBX Code 112

PBX Code 113

Branch
Office

Branch
Office

Extn. 301 Extn. 302
Extn. 401 Extn. 402
(DDI No.:
01-45-6789)
Note:

Public Call
Private Call

Conditions
•

266

Feature Guide

Each trunk has its service type: public, private, or VPN. Select VPN to use this service
through system programming.

1.28 Networking Features

•

Even if the telephone company does not support the VPN service, it is possible to use the
same kind of service when making a call by TIE line service programming, and/or Quick
Dialling programming ( 1.6.1.6 Quick Dialling).
[Quick Dialling Programming Example]
Location No.

Quick Dialling No.

Quick Dialling 01 2345 (extension no. of
other PBX)
:

:

Desired No.
9-123-4321 (Public no. of
extension 2345)
:

Explanation:
When an extension user dials "2345", he is connected to extension "2345" of other PBX
whose public number is "123-4321".

Feature Guide References
1.28.1 TIE Line Service

Feature Guide

267

1.28 Networking Features

1.28.3 QSIG Network
1.28.3.1 QSIG Network—SUMMARY
Description
QSIG is a protocol which is based on ISDN (Q.931) and offers enhanced PBX features in a
private network. The QSIG network supports private communications by the TIE line service
method.
Each ISDN (QSIG) connection must have a master port on one Panasonic Hybrid IP-PBX and
a slave port on the other Panasonic Hybrid IP-PBX to establish a QSIG network.
[Connection Example]
Extn.1000

PBX-1

:

(A) Master

(A) Slave

PBX-2

Extn. 2000
:

Extn.1999

Extn. 2999
(B) Master

QSIG Network

(C) Slave

(C) Master

(B) Slave
PBX-3

Extn. 3000
:
Extn. 3999

System programming controls the following services individually for each ISDN (QSIG) port.
[Service Table]
Service
Calling Line
Identification
Presentation (CLIP)
Connected Line
Identification
Presentation (COLP)
Calling Line
Identification
Restriction (CLIR)
Connected Line
Identification
Restriction (COLR)

268

Feature Guide

Description

Details in

Sends the caller’s number to the QSIG network • 1.28.3.2 Calling/
when making a call.
Connected Line
Identification
Presentation
Sends the number of the answered party to the
(CLIP/COLP) and
QSIG network when answering a call.
Calling/
Connected Name
Prevents the caller’s CLI being presented to the Identification
Presentation
called party by the caller.
(CNIP/CONP)—
by QSIG
Prevents COLP being sent by the answered
party.

1.28 Networking Features

Service

Description

Calling Name
Identification
Presentation (CNIP)

Sends the caller’s name to the QSIG network
when making a call.

Connected Name
Identification
Presentation (CONP)

Sends the name of the answered party to the
QSIG network when answering a call.

Calling Name
Identification
Restriction (CNIR)

Prevents the caller’s name being presented to
the called party by the caller.

Connected Name
Identification
Restriction (CONR)

Prevents CONP being sent by the answered
party.

Details in
• 1.28.3.2 Calling/
Connected Line
Identification
Presentation
(CLIP/COLP) and
Calling/
Connected Name
Identification
Presentation
(CNIP/CONP)—
by QSIG

Call Forwarding (CF)— Forwards a call to the QSIG network.
by QSIG*

• 1.28.3.3 Call
Forwarding
(CF)—by QSIG

Call Transfer (CT)—by Transfers a call to the QSIG network.
QSIG*

• 1.28.3.4 Call
Transfer (CT)—by
QSIG

Completion of Calls to Receives callback ringing when a busy called
Busy Subscriber
party on the QSIG network becomes free.
(CCBS)—by QSIG*

• 1.28.3.5
Completion of
Calls to Busy
Subscriber
(CCBS)—by
QSIG

*: This feature is not available for the PRI23 card.

Feature Guide References
1.20.1 Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)
1.28.1 TIE Line Service

Feature Guide

269

1.28 Networking Features

1.28.3.2 Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation
(CLIP/COLP) and Calling/Connected Name Identification
Presentation (CNIP/CONP)—by QSIG
Description
Calling Line/Name Identification Presentation (CLIP/CNIP):
The PBX can send a preprogrammed extension number and/or name to the QSIG network
when an extension user makes a call. The called party can see the number and/or name on
his telephone display before answering the call.
Connected Line/Name Identification Presentation (COLP/CONP):
The PBX sends a preprogrammed extension number and/or name to the QSIG network when
the extension user answers an incoming call. The caller can see the number and/or name of
the answering party on his telephone display when the call is answered.
These features comply with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications:
CLIP/COLP: ETS 300 172 Circuit mode basis services.
CNIP/CONP: ETS 300 238 Name identification supplementary services.
[CLIP/CNIP Example]
2) "John
101"
is displayed.

1) Dials "202".
PBX-1

CLIP: 101
CNIP: John

PBX-2

Caller
(Extn. No.: 101
Extn. Name: John)

Called party
(Extn. No.: 202)

[COLP/CONP Example]
1) Dials "203".
PBX-1

PBX-2

Called party
(Extn. No.: 203
Extn. Name: Tom)

FWD, IRNA, etc.
Caller
3) "Paul
204"
is displayed.

COLP: 204
CONP: Paul

Answering party
(Extn. No.: 204
Extn. Name: Paul)
2) Answers the call.

270

Feature Guide

1.28 Networking Features

CLIP/COLP Number:
The extension number sent to the QSIG network for CLIP/COLP can be assigned for each
extension through system programming ( Extension Number [003]).
CNIP/CONP Name:
The extension name sent to the QSIG network for CNIP/CONP can be assigned for each
extension through system programming ( Extension Name [004]).
Calling/Connected Line Identification Restriction (CLIR/COLR):
It is possible for each extension to restrict the sending of its extension number to the QSIG
network by pressing the CLIR button, COLR button, or entering the feature number.
Calling/Connected Name Identification Restriction (CNIR/CONR):
It is possible for each extension to restrict the sending of its extension name to the QSIG
network. When CLIR is activated, CNIR becomes active automatically. When COLR is
activated, CONR becomes active automatically.
These features comply with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications:
CLIR/COLR: ETS 300 172 Circuit mode basis services.
CNIR/CONR: ETS 300 238 Name identification supplementary services.

Conditions
•
•

COLP/CLIR/COLR/CNIP/CONP/CNIR/CONR Assignment for Each Port
Each service can be enabled or disabled on each ISDN (QSIG) port of the PBX.
CLIR Button and COLR Button
It is possible to switch between CLIP and CLIR by pressing the CLIR button, and COLP
and COLR by pressing the COLR button. A flexible button can be customised as the CLIR
or COLR button.

Feature Guide References
1.19.2 Flexible Buttons

User Manual References
User Manual
1.7.4 Displaying Your Telephone Number on the Called Party and Caller’s Telephone
(Calling/Connected Line Identification Presentation [CLIP/COLP])
1.7.5 Preventing Your Telephone Number Being Displayed on the Caller’s Telephone
(Connected Line Identification Restriction [COLR])
1.7.6 Preventing Your Number Being Displayed on the Called Party’s Telephone (Calling
Line Identification Restriction [CLIR])

Feature Guide

271

1.28 Networking Features

1.28.3.3 Call Forwarding (CF)—by QSIG
Description
The PBX forwards the call to a destination extension in another PBX in QSIG network. The
destination can be set on your own PBX on an extension basis as the forward destination of
trunk calls ( 1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD)).
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 257 Diversion supplementary services.
If the same trunk group is used for the incoming call and the forwarded call, the following
situation will be possible.
[Example]

QSIG
PBX-1

1

Extension 1000 of PBX-1
dials extension number
"2000", and the call is sent to
extension "2000" of PBX-2
through QSIG network.

2

The call is forwarded to the
forward destination of trunk
calls of extension 2000,
which is extension "1001" of
PBX-1.

3

The call between PBX-1 and
PBX-2 is released, and the
call is connected directly to
the forward destination of
extension 2000.

PBX-2
1 Call to 2000

2 Forwarded
to 1001

Extn. 1000 Extn. 1001

Extn. 2000
(Forward Destination
of Trunk Calls: 1001)

Dials "2000".

QSIG
PBX-1

PBX-2

3

Extn. 1000 Extn. 1001

Extn. 2000

Conditions
•

272

Feature Guide

This feature can be enabled or disabled on each ISDN (QSIG) port of the PBX.

1.28 Networking Features

User Manual References
User Manual
1.5.1 Forwarding Calls

Feature Guide

273

1.28 Networking Features

1.28.3.4 Call Transfer (CT)—by QSIG
Description
The PBX transfers the call to a destination extension in another PBX in QSIG network.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 261 Call transfer supplementary service.
If the same trunk group is used for the incoming call and the transferred call, the following
situation will be possible.
[Example]

QSIG
PBX-1

1

Extension 1000 of PBX-1
dials extension number
"2000", and the call is sent to
extension "2000" of PBX-2
through QSIG network.

2

The call is transferred from
extension 2000 to extension
"1001" of PBX-1.

3

The call between PBX-1 and
PBX-2 is released, and the
call is connected directly to
the transfer destination of
extension 2000.

PBX-2
1 Call to 2000

2 Transferred
to 1001

Extn. 1000 Extn. 1001

Extn. 2000

Dials "2000".

QSIG
PBX-1

PBX-2

3

Extn. 1000 Extn. 1001

Extn. 2000

Conditions
•
•

274

Feature Guide

This feature can be enabled or disabled on an ISDN (QSIG) port basis.
Call Transfer with Announcement and Call Transfer without Announcement is possible.
( 1.11.1 Call Transfer)

1.28 Networking Features

User Manual References
User Manual
1.4.1 Transferring a Call (Call Transfer)

Feature Guide

275

1.28 Networking Features

1.28.3.5 Completion of Calls to Busy Subscriber (CCBS)—by
QSIG
Description
If the call has been made to an extension in another PBX in QSIG network and the called party
is busy, an extension user can set to receive callback ringing when the called party becomes
free. When the user answers the callback ringing, that party's number is automatically dialled.
This feature complies with the following European Telecommunication Standard (ETS)
specifications: ETS 300 366 Call completion supplementary services.

Conditions
•

This feature is available under the following conditions:

a) The caller’s PBX is capable of using CCBS.
b) The called party's PBX is capable of accepting CCBS.
•
•
•

To receive and send CCBS, receiving and sending CCBS must be enabled individually on
an ISDN (QSIG) port basis through system programming.
An extension user can set only one CCBS. The last setting is effective.
The CCBS setting is cancelled if there is no callback ringing within 60 minutes or callback
ringing is not answered within 10 seconds.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.4 When the Dialled Line is Busy or There is No Answer

276

Feature Guide

1.28 Networking Features

1.28.4 Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) Network
Description
The PBX can connect to another PBX via a private IP network. In this case, voice signals are
converted into IP packets and sent through this network.
VoIP network supports the private network communications by the TIE line service method.
[Example]
PBX-1

PBX-2

Extn.1000

Extn.2000

Private IP
Network

IP-GW

:

Router

Extn.1999

IP-GW

:

Router

Dials "2999".

Extn.2999

PBX-3

Extn.3000
IP-GW

:

Router

Extn.3999

[Required Programming]
Device
PBX

Programming
For making a call:
•
ARS programming ( 1.9.1 Automatic Route
Selection (ARS)) or TIE line service
programming
For receiving a call:
•
TIE line service programming

IP-GW
(IP Gateway Circuit)

•

IP address assignment for the own PBX and
other PBXs.

Conditions
•

QSIG service is available. (

1.28.3 QSIG Network)

Feature Guide References
1.28.1 TIE Line Service

Feature Guide

277

1.29 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Features

1.29 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI)
Features
1.29.1 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI)
Description
Connecting a personal computer (PC) to this PBX (via a DPT with the USB Module, or via a
Server PC on a LAN) enables extension users to make use of advanced features by using the
stored data in the PC or in the Server PC.
There are two types of CTI as follows:

1) First Party Call Control
2) Third Party Call Control
1. First Party Call Control
A PC is connected to a DPT using a USB port (USB Module) attached to the DPT. The PC
monitors the status of the DPT and controls the DPT.
PBX

USB

PC

DPT

2. Third Party Call Control
A Server PC is connected to the PBX using the USB port on the PBX or using the CTILINK card as a CTI interface. PCs monitor the status of the PBX and control the PBX via
the Server PC.
PBX
CTI
Interface

PC

Server PC
LAN or USB

PC

LAN

278

Feature Guide

1.29 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Features

Conditions
•

Application Programming Interface (API)/Protocol
The following interface is required for First Party Call Control and Third Party Call Control:
Type

•

•

API/Protocol

First Party Call
Control

•

ECMA CSTA Phase 3

Third Party Call
Control

•
•

ECMA CSTA Phase 3
TAPI 2.1

The operating system of PC or Server PC required for First Party Call Control or Third
Party Call Control depends on your CTI application software. For details, refer to the
manual for your CTI application software.
One Server PC can be connected per PBX.

Installation Manual References
Installation Manual

2.3.1 MPR Card
2.6.6 CTI-LINK Card
2.7.4 First Party Call Control CTI Connection
2.11.1 Connection of Peripherals

6.6.4 First Party Call Control CTI Connection
6.10.1 Connection of Peripherals

Feature Guide

279

1.29 Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) Features

280

Feature Guide

Section

2

System Configuration and Administration
Features

Feature Guide

281

2.1 System Configuration—Hardware

2.1

System Configuration—Hardware

2.1.1

Extension Port Configuration

Description
There are three types of extension ports as follows:

a) DPT Port: DPT, DSS Console, Panasonic VPS (KX-TVS/TVP series [DPT (Digital)
Integration]), or PT-interface CS (e.g., KX-TDA0141) can be connected.

b) SLT Port: SLT or KX-TVS/TVP series (DTMF Integration) can be connected.
c) Super Hybrid Port: DPT, APT, SLT, DSS Console, KX-TVS/TVP series, or PTinterface CS can be connected.
EXtra Device Port (XDP) of Super Hybrid Ports:
A DPT and SLT can be connected to one Super Hybrid port (TR: SLT, HL: DPT). In this case,
the SLT port (TR) of the Super Hybrid port can be used as an XDP port to connect an SLT as
a sub telephone. There are two modes for the XDP port as follows:
Mode

Description

Parallel Mode

The DPT and SLT have the same extension number so that they
can act as one extension. They use the main telephone’s (DPT’s)
extension data (e.g., extension number, COS).
( 1.10.9 Parallelled Telephone)

XDP Mode

The DPT and SLT have different extension numbers so that they
can act as completely different extensions. To use XDP mode,
XDP mode must be enabled (on) the port through system
programming ( EXtra Device Port (XDP) Mode [600]).

Conditions
•

•
•

•

•

•

282

Feature Guide

Automatic Detection on Super Hybrid Port
A DPT, APT, SLT, or PT-interface CS can be connected to a Super Hybrid port without
programming.
A DSS Console or a VPS (Panasonic KX-TVS/TVP series [DPT (Digital) Integration]) can
also be connected with an SLT in XDP mode.
APT and SLT in Parallel Mode
An APT and an SLT can also be connected to a Super Hybrid port and used in parallel
mode.
Digital XDP
A DPT can be connected to another DPT and act as a completely different extension. (
1.10.9 Parallelled Telephone)
Wireless XDP Parallel Mode
A PS can be used in parallel mode with a wired telephone.
( 1.24.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode)
DSS Console and Paired Telephone Assignment
When a DSS Console is connected, a paired extension must be assigned through system
programming ( Console Paired Telephone [007]). Only a PT can be a paired extension.

2.2 System Configuration—Software

2.2

System Configuration—Software

2.2.1

Class of Service (COS)

Description
Each extension is assigned a COS number (
are controlled on a COS basis:

a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
h)
i)
j)
k)
l)
m)
n)
o)
p)
q)
r)

Internal Call Block (

s)
t)
u)
v)
w)

Wireless XDP Parallel Mode (

FWD (

1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block)

1.3.1.2 Call Forwarding (FWD))

DND Override (
Call Pickup (

1.3.1.3 Do Not Disturb (DND))
1.4.1.3 Call Pickup)

Account Code Entry (

1.5.4.3 Account Code Entry)

External Call Block (

1.5.5.3 Trunk Access)

Executive Busy Override (
Call Monitor (
OHCA (

1.7.2 Executive Busy Override)

1.7.3 Call Monitor)

1.7.4.3 Off-hook Call Announcement (OHCA))

Whisper OHCA (

1.7.4.4 Whisper OHCA)

TRS/Call Barring (
Extension Lock (
Walking COS (

1.8.1 Toll Restriction (TRS)/Call Barring (Barring))
1.8.3 Extension Lock)

1.8.5 Walking COS)

Trunk Call Limitation (
Call Transfer (
Door Open (
DISA (

Class of Service [602]). The following features

1.10.8 Trunk Call Limitation)

1.11.1 Call Transfer)
1.16.2 Door Open)

1.16.6 Direct Inward System Access (DISA))

Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN (P-MP) (
(P-MP))
SMDR for Outgoing Trunk Call (
Time Service Switching (
Manager Features (
PT Programming (

1.20.1.4 Call Forwarding (CF)—by ISDN

1.24.5 Wireless XDP Parallel Mode)
1.25.1 Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR))

2.2.4 Time Service)

2.2.6 Manager Features)
2.3.2 PT Programming)

Conditions
•

Walking COS
Extension users can make a call from other extensions of the lower level COS by using
their own higher level COS temporarily.

User Manual References
User Manual
1.2.7 Calling without Restrictions

Feature Guide

283

2.2 System Configuration—Software

2.2.2

Group

Description
This PBX supports various types of groups.

1. Trunk Group
Trunks can be grouped into a specified number of trunk groups (e.g., for each carrier, trunk
type, etc.) ( LCOT/BRI Trunk Group Number [402]). Several settings can be assigned
on a trunk group basis. All trunks belonging to a trunk group follow the assignment
determined for that trunk group.
One trunk can belong to only one trunk group on a port or channel basis.
Port basis: LCOT/DID/E & M/ISDN-BRI/ISDN-PRI23/ISDN-PRI30
Channel basis: E1/T1

2. User Group
The PBX supports user groups (
the following groups:

User Group [603]), each of which is used to compose

a) Tenant ( 2.2.3 Tenant Service)
b) Call Pickup Group (See below.)
c) Paging Group (See below.)
Every extension must belong to one user group, but cannot belong to more than one user
group.
Assignable Extensions: PT/SLT/PS/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX
[Example]
User Group 1

User Group 2

User Group 3

User Group 4

Extn. 100 Extn. 101

Extn. 102 Extn. 103

Extn. 104 Extn. 105

Extn. 106 Extn. 107

2.1 Call Pickup Group ( User Groups of a Pickup Group [650])
Using the Group Call Pickup feature, extensions can answer any calls within a
specified group. One user group can belong to several call pickup groups.
( 1.4.1.3 Call Pickup)
[Example]
Call Pickup Group 1

284

Feature Guide

Call Pickup Group 2

Call Pickup Group 3

User Group 1

User Group 2

User Group 3

User Group 4

Extn. 100 Extn. 101

Extn. 102 Extn. 103

Extn. 104 Extn. 105

Extn. 106 Extn. 107

2.2 System Configuration—Software

2.2 Paging Group ( User Groups of a Paging Group [640])
Using the Paging feature, extensions can make a page to any paging groups or
answer a page to their own groups. One user group or external pager can belong to
several paging groups.
( 1.14.1 Paging)
[Example]
Paging Group 1

Paging Group 2

Paging Group 3

User Group 1

User Group 2

User Group 3

Extn. 100 Extn. 101

Extn. 102 Extn. 103

Extn. 104 Extn. 105

Pager 1

Paging Group 4

Pager 2

3. Idle Extension Hunting Group
If a called extension is busy or in DND mode, Idle Extension Hunting redirects the
incoming call to an idle member of the same idle extension hunting group, which can be
programmed through system programming ( Idle Extension Hunting Group Member
[681]). Idle extensions are automatically searched according to a preprogrammed hunting
type: Circular Hunting or Terminated Hunting ( Idle Extension Hunting Type [680]).
( 1.2.1 Idle Extension Hunting)

4. Incoming Call Distribution Group
An incoming call distribution group is a group of extensions which receives incoming calls
directed to the group ( Incoming Call Distribution Group Member [620]). Each incoming
call distribution group has a floating extension number ( Incoming Call Distribution
Group Floating Extension Number [622]) and name ( Incoming Call Distribution Group
Name [623]). One extension can belong to multiple groups.
Assignable Extensions: PT/SLT/PS/ISDN Extension/T1-OPX/PS Ring Group
( 1.2.2 Incoming Call Distribution Group Features)
[Example]
Incoming Call
Distribution Group 1
(Floating Extn. No. 280,
Name: Sales 1)

Incoming Call
Distribution Group 2
(Floating Extn. No. 290,
Name: Sales 2)

Extn. 103 Extn. 104
Extn. 100 Extn. 101 Extn. 102

Extn. 105 Extn. 106 Extn. 107

Feature Guide

285

2.2 System Configuration—Software

5. VM Group
There are two types of VM groups as follows:
Type

Description

VM (DTMF) Group

A group of SLT ports which use the Voice Mail DTMF
Integration features.
One SLT port can belong to only one group.

VM (DPT) Group

A group of DPT ports ( VM Group Floating Extension
Number [660]) which use the Voice Mail DPT (Digital)
Integration features.
One DPT port can belong to only one group.

( 1.23.1 Voice Mail (VM) Group)
[Example]
PBX

SLT
Port

DPT
Port

DPT
Port

DPT
Port

DPT
Port

DPT
Port

SLT
Port

SLT
Port

SLT
Port

VM (DPT) Group

VM (DTMF) Group

VPS
(DPT [Digital] Integration)

VPS
(DTMF Integration)

SLT
Port

6. PS Ring Group
PS ring group is a group of PS extensions which receives incoming calls directed to the
group. Each group has a floating extension number and name through system
programming. One PS can belong to multiple groups.
( 1.24.2 PS Ring Group)
PS Ring Group 1
(Floating Extn. No. 301,
Name: Sales 1)

PS01
PS03
PS02

286

Feature Guide

PS Ring Group 2
(Floating Extn. No. 302,
Name: Sales 2)

PS04

PS06
PS05

2.2 System Configuration—Software

2.2.3

Tenant Service

Description
This PBX can be shared with certain number of tenants.

1. Tenant Configuration
1.1 Tenant Member
The tenant members consist of user groups. One user group can belong to only one
tenant. Therefore, one extension can belong to only one tenant.
( 2.2.2 Group)
1.2 Time Service
Each tenant has a Time Table. The Start and/or End time of each time mode (day/
lunch/break/night) can be set for each day of the week. The Time Table numbers
correspond to the tenant numbers respectively.
( 2.2.4 Time Service)
[Example]
Tenant 1

Tenant 2

User Group 1

User Group 5

User Group 2

User Group 6

User Group 3
User Group 4
Use Time Table 1

Use Time Table 2

2. System Management
Each of the following system management items can be assigned to each tenant.

a) Tenant Operator (extension number/floating extension number of incoming call
distribution group/none) (

2.2.5 Operator Features)

b) ARS Mode (Off/Local Access/All Access/System) (

1.9.1 Automatic Route

Selection (ARS))

c) Music Source for Music on Hold (System/BGM Number/Cyclic Tone)
(

1.12.4 Music on Hold)

Feature Guide

287

2.2 System Configuration—Software

[Programming Example]
Tenant No.

Operator

ARS Mode

Music Source

1

Extn.101

Local Access

System*3

2

None*1

System*2

Cyclic Tone

3

Floating extn. no. 200

Off

BGM1

:

:

:

:

*1 :
*2 :
*3 :

Follows the system assignment of a PBX operator ( Operator Assignment [006])
Follows the system assignment of the ARS mode ( ARS Mode [320])
Follows the system assignment of the music source for the Music on Hold
( Music on Hold [711])

Conditions
•

Tenant-to-Tenant Call Block
The following features can be restricted based on the COS for each extension (not based
on the tenant) by the Internal Call Block feature ( 1.1.2.2 Internal Call Block):
– Calling extensions or doorphone(s) in the restricted tenant(s)
– Picking up calls ringing in the restricted tenant(s)
– Retrieving a call held within the restricted tenant(s).
[Example]

Tenant 1

Tenant 2

Extension Group 1

Extension Group 3

Extn. 100 Extn. 101

Extn. 104 Extn. 105

COS 1

COS 2

COS 3

Tenant 3

Extension Group 2

COS 4
Extension Group 4

Extension Group 5

Extn. 102 Extn. 103

Extn. 106 Extn. 107
Extn. 108 Extn. 109
COS 5

COS 6
Extension Group 6

Extn. 110 Extn. 111

288

Feature Guide

2.2 System Configuration—Software

[Programming Example]
Called Party
Caller
COS 1

COS 2

COS 3

COS 4

COS 5

COS 6

...

COS 1

...

COS 2

...

COS 3

...

COS 4

...

COS 5

...

COS 6

...

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

:

: Block
Explanation:

1. Assign each extension in a tenant to a certain COS number. Each tenant must have
unique COS numbers.
Tenant 1: COS 1 and COS 2
Tenant 2: COS 3 and COS 4
Tenant 3: COS 5 and COS 6

2. Tenant-to-Tenant Call Block enables by the Internal Call Block feature.
a) Tenant 1 (COS 1 and COS 2) can make calls to both Tenant 2 (COS 3 and COS
4) and Tenant 3 (COS 5 and COS 6) as well as Tenant 1.

b) Tenant 2 (COS 3 and COS 4) can make calls to Tenant 1 (COS 1 and COS 2)
and Tenant 2.

c) Tenant 3 (COS 5 and COS 6) can make calls to Tenant 3 itself only.
•

An incoming call distribution group must belong to one tenant because the following
features are determined on a tenant basis ( 1.2.2.1 Incoming Call Distribution Group
Features—SUMMARY):
– Music on Hold while a call is waiting in the queue
– The Time Table which determines the overflow destination.

Feature Guide

289

2.2 System Configuration—Software

2.2.4

Time Service

Description
This PBX supports day, night, lunch, and break modes of operation. TRS/Barring can be
arranged separately. The destination of incoming calls can be set differently for each mode.

1. Time Service Switching Mode
Day/lunch/break/night mode can be switched either automatically or manually ( Time
Service Switching Mode [101]). The switching mode can be assigned for each tenant.
The switching mode can also be changed by pressing the Time Service Switching Mode
(Automatic/Manual) button. This can be performed by only an extension assigned as the
manager, or preprogrammed extension on a COS basis ( Time Service Manual
Switching [514]).
Type

Description

Automatic

The PBX will switch mode according to the preprogrammed Time
Table.

Manual

A manager, or preprogrammed extension on a COS basis ( Time
Service Manual Switching [514]) can switch mode by dialling the
feature number or pressing the Time Service button.

Even while in the Automatic Switching mode, day/lunch/break/night mode can be changed
manually.

2. Time Table
Each tenant has a Time Table used for the Automatic Switching mode. The Start and/or
End time of each mode can be set for each day of the week. The Time Table numbers
correspond to the tenant numbers respectively.

290

Feature Guide

2.2 System Configuration—Software

[Time Table Example]
Time Schedule
MON Day 1 start
Lunch start
Day 2 start
Break 1 start
Break 1 end (Day restart)
Night start
TUE Day 1 start
Lunch start
Day 2 start
Break 1 start
Break 1 end (Day restart)
Night start
:
:

Time Table No. (Tenant No.)
1
2
3
4
08:00
11:00
08:00
08:00
12:00
NONE
16:00
12:00
13:00
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
16:00
20:00
12:00
NONE
08:00
11:00
08:00
08:00
12:05
NONE
13:00
13:00
13:00
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
NONE
16:31
20:00
17:00
NONE
:
:
:
:

…
…
…
…
…
…
…
…
…
…
…
…
…
…